000126165409/302020FYfalseus-gaap:AccountingStandardsUpdate201409Memberus-gaap:AccountingStandardsUpdate201602Memberus-gaap:PropertyPlantAndEquipmentAndFinanceLeaseRightOfUseAssetAfterAccumulatedDepreciationAndAmortizationus-gaap:OtherLiabilitiesCurrentus-gaap:OtherLiabilitiesNoncurrentP7YP3Y00012616542019-10-012020-09-30xbrli:shares00012616542020-11-30iso4217:USD00012616542020-03-3100012616542020-09-3000012616542019-09-30iso4217:USDxbrli:shares00012616542018-10-012019-09-3000012616542017-10-012018-09-300001261654us-gaap:CommonStockMember2017-09-300001261654us-gaap:PreferredStockMember2017-09-300001261654us-gaap:AdditionalPaidInCapitalMemberus-gaap:CommonStockMember2017-09-300001261654us-gaap:AdditionalPaidInCapitalMemberus-gaap:SeriesAPreferredStockMember2017-09-300001261654us-gaap:TreasuryStockMember2017-09-300001261654us-gaap:RetainedEarningsMember2017-09-3000012616542017-09-3000012616542016-10-012017-09-300001261654us-gaap:RetainedEarningsMembersrt:CumulativeEffectPeriodOfAdoptionAdjustmentMember2017-09-300001261654srt:CumulativeEffectPeriodOfAdoptionAdjustmentMember2017-09-300001261654us-gaap:RetainedEarningsMember2017-10-012018-09-300001261654us-gaap:CommonStockMember2017-10-012018-09-300001261654us-gaap:AdditionalPaidInCapitalMemberus-gaap:CommonStockMember2017-10-012018-09-300001261654us-gaap:CommonStockMember2018-09-300001261654us-gaap:PreferredStockMember2018-09-300001261654us-gaap:AdditionalPaidInCapitalMemberus-gaap:CommonStockMember2018-09-300001261654us-gaap:AdditionalPaidInCapitalMemberus-gaap:SeriesAPreferredStockMember2018-09-300001261654us-gaap:TreasuryStockMember2018-09-300001261654us-gaap:RetainedEarningsMember2018-09-3000012616542018-09-300001261654us-gaap:RetainedEarningsMember2018-10-012019-09-300001261654us-gaap:CommonStockMember2018-10-012019-09-300001261654us-gaap:AdditionalPaidInCapitalMemberus-gaap:CommonStockMember2018-10-012019-09-300001261654us-gaap:CommonStockMember2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:PreferredStockMember2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:AdditionalPaidInCapitalMemberus-gaap:CommonStockMember2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:AdditionalPaidInCapitalMemberus-gaap:SeriesAPreferredStockMember2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:TreasuryStockMember2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:RetainedEarningsMember2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:RetainedEarningsMembersrt:CumulativeEffectPeriodOfAdoptionAdjustmentMember2019-09-300001261654srt:CumulativeEffectPeriodOfAdoptionAdjustmentMember2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:RetainedEarningsMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654us-gaap:CommonStockMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654us-gaap:AdditionalPaidInCapitalMemberus-gaap:CommonStockMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654us-gaap:TreasuryStockMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654us-gaap:CommonStockMember2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:PreferredStockMember2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:AdditionalPaidInCapitalMemberus-gaap:CommonStockMember2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:AdditionalPaidInCapitalMemberus-gaap:SeriesAPreferredStockMember2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:TreasuryStockMember2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:RetainedEarningsMember2020-09-30uti:campusuti:technicianuti:planxbrli:pure0001261654srt:MinimumMember2020-09-300001261654srt:MaximumMember2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:AccountingStandardsUpdate201602Member2019-10-01uti:lease0001261654us-gaap:AccountingStandardsUpdate201602Member2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:AccountingStandardsUpdate201602Memberus-gaap:RetainedEarningsMembersrt:CumulativeEffectPeriodOfAdoptionAdjustmentMember2019-10-010001261654us-gaap:AccountingStandardsUpdate201602Memberus-gaap:RetainedEarningsMembersrt:CumulativeEffectPeriodOfAdoptionAdjustmentMember2020-06-300001261654us-gaap:SubsequentEventMemberus-gaap:AccountingStandardsUpdate201613Member2020-10-01uti:student00012616542020-03-2500012616542020-05-012020-05-3100012616542020-06-012020-06-300001261654uti:StudentsMember2020-09-3000012616542020-07-312020-07-310001261654uti:FormerPresidentAndChiefExecutiveOfficerMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654srt:MinimumMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654srt:MaximumMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654us-gaap:EmployeeSeveranceMember2018-09-300001261654us-gaap:OtherRestructuringMember2018-09-300001261654us-gaap:EmployeeSeveranceMember2018-10-012019-09-300001261654us-gaap:OtherRestructuringMember2018-10-012019-09-300001261654us-gaap:EmployeeSeveranceMember2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:OtherRestructuringMember2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:EmployeeSeveranceMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654us-gaap:OtherRestructuringMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654us-gaap:EmployeeSeveranceMember2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:OtherRestructuringMember2020-09-3000012616542020-02-012020-02-290001261654us-gaap:CorporateDebtSecuritiesMember2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:MoneyMarketFundsMember2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:MoneyMarketFundsMemberus-gaap:FairValueInputsLevel1Member2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:MoneyMarketFundsMemberus-gaap:FairValueInputsLevel2Member2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:MoneyMarketFundsMemberus-gaap:FairValueInputsLevel3Member2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:NotesReceivableMember2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:NotesReceivableMemberus-gaap:FairValueInputsLevel1Member2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:NotesReceivableMemberus-gaap:FairValueInputsLevel2Member2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:NotesReceivableMemberus-gaap:FairValueInputsLevel3Member2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:CorporateBondSecuritiesMember2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:CorporateBondSecuritiesMemberus-gaap:FairValueInputsLevel1Member2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:CorporateBondSecuritiesMemberus-gaap:FairValueInputsLevel2Member2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:CorporateBondSecuritiesMemberus-gaap:FairValueInputsLevel3Member2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:MunicipalBondsMember2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:MunicipalBondsMemberus-gaap:FairValueInputsLevel1Member2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:MunicipalBondsMemberus-gaap:FairValueInputsLevel2Member2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:MunicipalBondsMemberus-gaap:FairValueInputsLevel3Member2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMember2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:FairValueInputsLevel1Member2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:FairValueInputsLevel2Member2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:FairValueInputsLevel3Member2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:MoneyMarketFundsMember2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:MoneyMarketFundsMemberus-gaap:FairValueInputsLevel1Member2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:MoneyMarketFundsMemberus-gaap:FairValueInputsLevel2Member2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:MoneyMarketFundsMemberus-gaap:FairValueInputsLevel3Member2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:NotesReceivableMember2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:NotesReceivableMemberus-gaap:FairValueInputsLevel1Member2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:NotesReceivableMemberus-gaap:FairValueInputsLevel2Member2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:NotesReceivableMemberus-gaap:FairValueInputsLevel3Member2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMember2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:FairValueInputsLevel1Member2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:FairValueInputsLevel2Member2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:EstimateOfFairValueFairValueDisclosureMemberus-gaap:FairValueMeasurementsRecurringMemberus-gaap:FairValueInputsLevel3Member2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:LandMember2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:LandMember2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:BuildingAndBuildingImprovementsMembersrt:MinimumMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654us-gaap:BuildingAndBuildingImprovementsMembersrt:MaximumMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654us-gaap:BuildingAndBuildingImprovementsMember2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:BuildingAndBuildingImprovementsMember2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:LeaseholdImprovementsMembersrt:MinimumMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654us-gaap:LeaseholdImprovementsMembersrt:MaximumMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654us-gaap:LeaseholdImprovementsMember2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:LeaseholdImprovementsMember2019-09-300001261654srt:MinimumMemberuti:TrainingEquipmentMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654srt:MaximumMemberuti:TrainingEquipmentMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654uti:TrainingEquipmentMember2020-09-300001261654uti:TrainingEquipmentMember2019-09-300001261654srt:MinimumMemberuti:OfficeAndComputerEquipmentMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654uti:OfficeAndComputerEquipmentMembersrt:MaximumMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654uti:OfficeAndComputerEquipmentMember2020-09-300001261654uti:OfficeAndComputerEquipmentMember2019-09-300001261654uti:CurriculumDevelopmentMember2020-09-300001261654uti:CurriculumDevelopmentMember2019-09-300001261654srt:MinimumMemberus-gaap:SoftwareDevelopmentMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654srt:MaximumMemberus-gaap:SoftwareDevelopmentMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654us-gaap:SoftwareDevelopmentMember2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:SoftwareDevelopmentMember2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:VehiclesMember2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:VehiclesMember2019-09-300001261654srt:MinimumMemberuti:RightOfUseAssetsForFinanceLeasesMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654uti:RightOfUseAssetsForFinanceLeasesMembersrt:MaximumMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654us-gaap:ConstructionInProgressMember2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:ConstructionInProgressMember2019-09-30uti:location0001261654uti:JohnCWhiteLeasedPropertyOneMember2020-09-300001261654uti:JohnCWhiteLeasedPropertyTwoMember2020-09-3000012616542012-09-300001261654us-gaap:OtherNonoperatingIncomeExpenseMember2018-10-012019-09-300001261654us-gaap:OtherNonoperatingIncomeExpenseMember2017-10-012018-09-300001261654uti:EducationServicesAndFacilitiesMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654uti:InvestmentinJVMember2020-09-300001261654uti:InvestmentinJVMember2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:ValuationAllowanceOfDeferredTaxAssetsMember2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:ValuationAllowanceOfDeferredTaxAssetsMember2018-09-300001261654us-gaap:ValuationAllowanceOfDeferredTaxAssetsMember2017-09-300001261654us-gaap:ValuationAllowanceOfDeferredTaxAssetsMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654us-gaap:ValuationAllowanceOfDeferredTaxAssetsMember2018-10-012019-09-300001261654us-gaap:ValuationAllowanceOfDeferredTaxAssetsMember2017-10-012018-09-300001261654us-gaap:ValuationAllowanceOfDeferredTaxAssetsMember2020-09-300001261654uti:DeferredTaxAssetRelatedToASC606AdoptionMember2017-10-012017-10-010001261654uti:DeferredTaxAssetRelatedToASC842AdoptionMember2019-10-012020-09-3000012616542018-01-012019-12-310001261654country:US2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:StateAndLocalJurisdictionMember2020-09-300001261654uti:TaxYear2039Member2020-09-300001261654uti:LicensingAgreementOneMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654uti:LicensingAgreementOneMember2018-10-012019-09-300001261654uti:LicensingAgreementOneMember2017-10-012018-09-300001261654uti:LicensingAgreementTwoMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654uti:LicensingAgreementTwoMember2018-10-012019-09-300001261654uti:LicensingAgreementTwoMember2017-10-012018-09-300001261654uti:LicensingAgreementThreeMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654uti:LicensingAgreementThreeMember2017-10-012018-09-300001261654uti:LicensingAgreementThreeMember2018-10-012019-09-3000012616542015-04-012015-04-30uti:option0001261654uti:LicensingAgreementFourMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654uti:LicensingAgreementFourMember2018-10-012019-09-300001261654uti:LicensingAgreementFourMember2017-10-012018-09-300001261654us-gaap:SuretyBondMember2020-09-30uti:vote0001261654us-gaap:SeriesAPreferredStockMember2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:SeriesAPreferredStockMember2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:SeriesAPreferredStockMember2016-06-240001261654us-gaap:PreferredStockIncludingAdditionalPaidInCapitalMember2016-06-242016-06-2400012616542016-06-242016-06-240001261654us-gaap:SeriesAPreferredStockMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654srt:MinimumMemberus-gaap:SeriesAPreferredStockMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654srt:MaximumMemberus-gaap:SeriesAPreferredStockMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654us-gaap:SeriesAPreferredStockMember2020-08-012020-08-31uti:holder00012616542020-08-3100012616542020-09-142020-09-14uti:day0001261654uti:PublicOfferingMember2020-02-202020-02-200001261654uti:PublicOfferingMember2020-02-200001261654us-gaap:OverAllotmentOptionMember2020-02-202020-02-2000012616542020-02-252020-02-250001261654uti:PublicOfferingMember2019-10-012020-09-3000012616542011-12-2000012616542011-12-212020-09-300001261654uti:Management2002StockOptionProgramMember2002-04-010001261654uti:Management2002StockOptionProgramMember2003-02-252003-02-250001261654uti:A2003IncentiveCompensationPlanMember2003-12-220001261654uti:A2003IncentiveCompensationPlanMember2020-09-300001261654uti:EducationalServicesAndFacilitiesMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654uti:EducationalServicesAndFacilitiesMember2018-10-012019-09-300001261654uti:EducationalServicesAndFacilitiesMember2017-10-012018-09-300001261654us-gaap:SellingGeneralAndAdministrativeExpensesMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654us-gaap:SellingGeneralAndAdministrativeExpensesMember2018-10-012019-09-300001261654us-gaap:SellingGeneralAndAdministrativeExpensesMember2017-10-012018-09-300001261654srt:MinimumMemberuti:A2003IncentiveCompensationPlanMemberus-gaap:EmployeeStockOptionMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654uti:A2003IncentiveCompensationPlanMembersrt:MaximumMemberus-gaap:EmployeeStockOptionMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654uti:A2003IncentiveCompensationPlanMemberus-gaap:EmployeeStockOptionMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654us-gaap:EmployeeStockOptionMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654us-gaap:RestrictedStockUnitsRSUMember2017-09-300001261654us-gaap:PerformanceSharesMember2017-09-300001261654us-gaap:RestrictedStockUnitsRSUMember2017-10-012018-09-300001261654us-gaap:PerformanceSharesMember2017-10-012018-09-300001261654us-gaap:RestrictedStockUnitsRSUMember2018-09-300001261654us-gaap:PerformanceSharesMember2018-09-300001261654us-gaap:RestrictedStockUnitsRSUMember2018-10-012019-09-300001261654us-gaap:PerformanceSharesMember2018-10-012019-09-300001261654us-gaap:RestrictedStockUnitsRSUMember2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:PerformanceSharesMember2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:RestrictedStockUnitsRSUMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654us-gaap:PerformanceSharesMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654us-gaap:RestrictedStockUnitsRSUMember2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:PerformanceSharesMember2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:RestrictedStockUnitsRSUMembersrt:MinimumMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654us-gaap:RestrictedStockUnitsRSUMembersrt:MaximumMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654srt:MinimumMemberus-gaap:PerformanceSharesMember2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:PerformanceSharesMembersrt:MaximumMember2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:RestrictedStockMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654us-gaap:RestrictedStockMember2018-10-012019-09-300001261654us-gaap:RestrictedStockMember2017-10-012018-09-300001261654us-gaap:ConvertiblePreferredStockMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654us-gaap:ConvertiblePreferredStockMember2018-10-012019-09-300001261654us-gaap:ConvertiblePreferredStockMember2017-10-012018-09-300001261654uti:PostsecondaryEducationMemberus-gaap:OperatingSegmentsMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654us-gaap:CorporateNonSegmentMemberus-gaap:AllOtherSegmentsMember2019-10-012020-09-300001261654uti:PostsecondaryEducationMemberus-gaap:OperatingSegmentsMember2018-10-012019-09-300001261654us-gaap:CorporateNonSegmentMemberus-gaap:AllOtherSegmentsMember2018-10-012019-09-300001261654uti:PostsecondaryEducationMemberus-gaap:OperatingSegmentsMember2017-10-012018-09-300001261654us-gaap:CorporateNonSegmentMemberus-gaap:AllOtherSegmentsMember2017-10-012018-09-300001261654uti:PostsecondaryEducationMemberus-gaap:OperatingSegmentsMember2020-09-300001261654us-gaap:CorporateNonSegmentMemberus-gaap:AllOtherSegmentsMember2020-09-300001261654uti:PostsecondaryEducationMemberus-gaap:OperatingSegmentsMember2019-09-300001261654us-gaap:CorporateNonSegmentMemberus-gaap:AllOtherSegmentsMember2019-09-3000012616542018-10-012018-12-3100012616542017-10-012017-12-3100012616542020-03-152020-09-300001261654us-gaap:SubsequentEventMember2020-10-3100012616542019-10-012019-12-3100012616542020-01-012020-03-3100012616542020-04-012020-06-3000012616542020-07-012020-09-3000012616542019-01-012019-03-3100012616542019-04-012019-06-3000012616542019-07-012019-09-30

_____________________________________________________________________________________________________________
UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549
FORM 10-K
(Mark One)

ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the fiscal year ended September 30, 2020
 
TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 
For the transition period from _____ to ______
Commission File Number 1-31923

 UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC.
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
Delaware   86-0226984
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)
  (IRS Employer Identification No.)
4225 East Windrose Drive, Suite 200
Phoenix, Arizona 85032
(Address of principal executive offices)
(623) 445-9500
(Registrant’s telephone number, including area code)

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

Title of each class Trading Symbol  Name of each exchange on which registered
Common Stock, $0.0001 par value UTI New York Stock Exchange

Securities registered pursuant to section 12(g) of the Act: None.

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. Yes No  

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act. Yes No  
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.    Yes     No  
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically every Interactive Data File required to be submitted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit such files).    Yes       No   
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, a smaller reporting company, or an emerging growth company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” “smaller reporting company,” and "emerging growth company" in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.



Large accelerated filer
 Accelerated filer      
Non-accelerated filer   
 Smaller reporting company ☐ 
 Emerging growth company ☐ 

If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act.

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has filed a report on and attestation to its management’s assessment of the effectiveness of its internal control over financial reporting under Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act (15 U.S.C. 7262(b)) by the registered public accounting firm that prepared or issued its audit report.

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act).    Yes      No  

At November 30, 2020, 32,647,362 shares of common stock were outstanding. The aggregate market value of the shares of common stock held by non-affiliates of the registrant on the last business day of the registrant's most recently completed second fiscal quarter (March 31, 2020) was approximately $170,000,000 (based upon the closing price of the common stock on such date as reported by the New York Stock Exchange). For purposes of this calculation, the registrant has excluded the market value of all common stock beneficially owned by all executive officers and directors of the registrant.

Documents Incorporated by Reference

Portions of the registrant's definitive proxy statement for the 2021 Annual Meeting of Stockholders are incorporated by reference into Part III of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.




UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
INDEX TO FORM 10-K FOR THE FISCAL YEAR ENDED SEPTEMBER 30, 2020


Page
1
ITEM 1.
3
ITEM 1A.
19
ITEM 1B.
34
ITEM 2.
34
ITEM 3.
35
ITEM 4.
35
ITEM 5.
36
ITEM 6.
38
ITEM 7.
39
ITEM 7A.
56
ITEM 8.
56
ITEM 9.
56
ITEM 9A.
56
ITEM 9B.
57
ITEM 10.
58
ITEM 11.
58
ITEM 12.
58
ITEM 13.
59
ITEM 14.
59
ITEM 15.
60
i

Table of Contents
CAUTIONARY NOTE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

This Annual Report on Form 10-K and the documents incorporated by reference herein contain forward-looking statements within the meaning of Section 21E of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (“Exchange Act”), Section 27A of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (“Securities Act”) and the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995, which include information relating to future events, future financial performance, strategies, expectations, competitive environment, regulation and availability of resources and involve known and unknown risks, uncertainties and other factors which may cause our actual results, performance or achievements to be materially different from any future results, performances or achievements expressed or implied by the forward-looking statements. From time to time, we also provide forward-looking statements in other materials we release to the public as well as verbal forward-looking statements.

In some cases, you can identify forward-looking statements by terms such as “may,” “will,” “should,” “could,” “would,” “expects,” “plans,” “anticipates,” “believes,” “estimates,” “projects,” “predicts,” “potential” and similar expressions (including the negative form of such expressions) intended to identify forward-looking statements, although not all forward-looking statements contain these identifying words. Forward-looking statements are based on our current expectations and assumptions, do not strictly relate to historical or current facts, any of which may not prove to be accurate. Many factors could cause actual results to differ materially and adversely from these forward-looking statements. Important factors that could cause actual results to differ from those in our forward-looking statements include, without limitation:

failure of our schools to comply with the extensive regulatory requirements for school operations;
our failure to maintain eligibility for federal student financial assistance funds;
continued Congressional examination of the for-profit education sector;
a disruption in our ability to process student loans under the Federal Direct Loan Program;
regulatory investigations of, or actions commenced against, us or other companies in our industry;
the effect of public health pandemics, epidemics or outbreak, including COVID-19;
changes in the state regulatory environment or budgetary constraints;
our failure to improve underutilized capacity at certain of our campuses;
enrollment declines or challenges in our students’ ability to find employment as a result of macroeconomic conditions;
our failure to maintain and expand existing industry relationships and develop new industry relationships with our industry customers;
our ability to update and expand the content of existing programs and develop and integrate new programs in a cost-effective manner and on a timely basis;
our failure to effectively identify, establish and operate additional schools, programs or campuses;
the effect of our principal stockholder owning a significant percentage of our capital stock, and thus being able to influence certain corporate matters and the potential in the future to gain substantial control over our company;
the impact of certain holders of our Series A Preferred Stock owning a significant percentage of our capital stock, their ability to influence and control certain corporate matters and the potential for future dilution to holders of our common stock;
loss of our senior management or other key employees; and
risks related to other factors discussed in this Annual Report on Form 10-K, including those described in Item 1A. “Risk Factors.”

The factors above are not exhaustive, and new factors may emerge or changes to the foregoing factors may occur that could impact our business. We cannot guarantee that any forward-looking statement will be realized. Achievement of future results is subject to risks, uncertainties and potentially inaccurate assumptions. Many events beyond our control may determine whether results we anticipate will be achieved. Should known or unknown risks or uncertainties materialize, or should underlying assumptions prove inaccurate, actual results could differ materially from past results and those anticipated, estimated or projected. Among the factors that could cause actual results to differ materially are the factors discussed under Item 1A. “Risk Factors,” Item 1. “Business,” and Item 7. “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.” You should bear this in mind as you consider forward-looking statements.

Also, these forward-looking statements represent our estimates and assumptions only as of the date of the document containing the applicable statement. Except as required by law, we undertake no obligation to update or revise forward-looking statements, whether as a result of new information, future events or otherwise. Thus, you should not assume that our silence over time means that actual events are bearing out as expressed or implied in such forward-looking statements. We qualify all of the forward-looking statements in this Annual Report on Form 10-K, including the documents that we
1

Table of Contents
incorporate by reference herein, by these cautionary statements. You are advised, however, to consult any further disclosures we make on related subjects in our reports and filings with the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”).




2

Table of Contents
PART I
ITEM 1. BUSINESS
Overview
Universal Technical Institute, Inc. (“we,” “us” or “our”) is the leading provider of postsecondary education for students seeking careers as professional automotive, diesel, collision repair, motorcycle and marine technicians as measured by total average full-time enrollment and graduates. We also provide programs for welders and computer numeric control (“CNC”) machining technicians. We offer certificate, diploma or degree programs at 12 campuses across the United States under the banner of several well-known brands, including Universal Technical Institute (“UTI”), Motorcycle Mechanics Institute and Marine Mechanics Institute (collectively, “MMI”) and NASCAR Technical Institute (“NASCAR Tech”). Additionally, we offer manufacturer specific advanced training (“MSAT”) programs, including student-paid electives, at our campuses and manufacturer or dealer sponsored training at certain campuses and dedicated training centers. Founded in 1965, we have provided technical education for more than 55 years and have graduated more than 220,000 technicians.
All of our campuses are nationally accredited and are eligible for federal student financial assistance funds under the Higher Education Act of 1965, as amended (“HEA”), commonly referred to as Title IV Programs, which are administered by the U.S. Department of Education (“ED”). Our programs are also eligible for financial aid from federal sources other than Title IV Programs, such as the programs administered by the U.S. Department of Veterans Affairs (“VA”) and under the Workforce Investment Act.
Business Model and Industry Partnerships
Our goal is to continue to be the leading provider of postsecondary education for students seeking careers as professional technicians. We continue to evolve our business model to provide our students with accessible, affordable training with a focus on bringing education to the students at convenient locations. The market for qualified service technicians is large and growing. The United States Department of Labor Bureau of Labor Statistics (“U.S. DOL BLS”) estimates that an average of approximately 99,800 new job openings, due to growth and net replacements, will exist annually for newly trained technicians in the automotive, diesel, and collision fields through 2029. Additionally, the U.S. DOL BLS estimates that an average of 43,400 new job openings for welders, 11,800 new job openings for computer-controlled machine tool operators, and 4,200 new job openings for marine and motorcycle technicians will exist annually for new entrants through 2029 in these fields.
Our student recruitment efforts begin with our commitment to positive outcomes, both for our students and our industry relationships. Our responsibility to present job-ready graduates to employers requires that we recruit, enroll and train prospective students who have the drive and potential to successfully pursue a career in their field of training. We use a multi-touch media approach for our three primary admissions channels (high school, adult, and military) to enroll and start students, which involves national and local outreach to generate a high quality and quantity of prospective students. To maximize the likelihood of student retention and graduation, our admissions process is intended to identify students who have the desire and ability to succeed in their chosen program. In addition, we have established processes to identify students who may be in need of assistance to succeed in and complete their chosen program. To assist these students in graduating, we employ student service professionals that provide tutoring, and academic, financial, personal, and employment advisement. Additionally, as our campus locations do not offer housing for students, we have service professionals who leverage third-party relationships and assist our students in finding affordable housing near our campuses.
To ensure our programs provide students with the necessary hard and soft skills needed upon graduation, we have relationships with over 35 original equipment manufacturers and industry brand partners across the country to understand their needs for qualified service professionals. Through our industry relationships, we are able to continuously refine and expand our programs and curricula. We believe our industry-focused educational model and national presence have enabled us to develop valuable industry relationships, which provide us with significant competitive strengths and supports our market leadership, along with enabling us to provide highly specialized education to our students, resulting in enhanced employment opportunities and the potential for higher wages for our graduates.
Our industry relationships also extend to thousands of local employers, after-market retailers, fleet service providers and enthusiast organizations. Other target groups for relationship-building, such as parts and tools suppliers, provide us with a
3

Table of Contents
variety of strategic and financial benefits that include equipment sponsorship, new product support, licensing and branding opportunities and financial sponsorship for our campuses and students.
As a result of the COVID-19 pandemic during 2020, we have transitioned our on-campus, in-person education model to a blended training model that combines instructor-facilitated online teaching and demonstrations with hands-on labs. On-campus labs have been redesigned to meet the health, safety and social distancing guidelines imposed by the Centers for Disease Control (“CDC”) and state and local jurisdictions, while still meeting our accreditation and curriculum requirements. Both the ED and the Accrediting Commission of Career Schools and Colleges (“ACCSC”) granted institutions temporary approval to offer distance learning through December 31, 2020. To afford us additional flexibility beyond the current temporary approval period(s), we have initiated the approval process with the ACCSC and the appropriate state agencies to be able to offer distance education and a blended learning format for all of our programs on a more permanent basis. Additionally, we continue to invest in the online delivery platform and curriculum to further enhance the student experience.
Business Strategy
In support of our goal to continue to be the leading provider of postsecondary education for students seeking careers as professional automotive, diesel, collision repair, motorcycle and marine technicians, as well as welders and CNC machining technicians, and the leading supplier of entry-level skilled technicians for the industries we serve, we are pursuing a number of business strategies. Additionally, we are focused on growth and diversification which is achieved through the expansion of new program offerings, funding models, and business operating models.

Return on Education

We provide an excellent return on our students’ education investment by working with our industry partners to offer manufacturer-specific training that is tailored to industry standards and requirements, that improves students’ opportunities to find employment and maximizes their earnings potential. We actively engage transportation industry partners in defining our core curriculum and improving and expanding our MSAT courses. We regularly evaluate program offerings, schedules and locations that are most appealing to students and aligned with employer expectations. We also update and expand our core and MSAT courses to align our training programs with current industry standards and requirements.

These unique industry-aligned course offerings make our students more valuable to employers by giving them training that is consistent with industry needs and rapidly changing technology and the opportunity to earn a variety of industry-recognized certifications and credentials. As a result, we believe we are well positioned to better meet the industry’s demand for skilled technicians.

Strengthen Industry Relationships

Our relationships with leading manufacturer brand partners and other strategic partners are important to our business. We deliver value to these partners and employers by functioning as an efficient hiring source and low cost training option for new and existing technicians. These relationships give us direct input on the latest needs and requirements of employers, which not only guides our prospective student recruitment, but also strengthens our curricula and our students’ opportunities for employment and higher earnings after graduation. In addition, our manufacturer brand partners support our students through manufacturer-paid courses, scholarships, tuition reimbursement programs and early employment initiatives.

Recruit, Train and Identify Employment Opportunities for More Students

Our student recruitment efforts begin with our commitment to positive outcomes for our students and our industry relationships. Our responsibility to present job-ready graduates to employers requires that we recruit, enroll and train prospective students who have the drive and potential to successfully pursue a career in their field of training. We use a multi-touch media approach that involves national and local outreach to generate the quality and quantity of prospective students necessary for our three primary admissions channels to enroll and start students.

Our marketing strategy leverages an integrated inquiry generation platform that focuses on generating awareness and engagement, both nationally and locally, where our website acts as the primary hub of our campaigns, to inform and educate potential students on the nature of our educational programs and the employment opportunities that could be available to them. Currently, we advertise on television, internet search, social media, display, online video and other internet-based content, radio, billboards and in magazines.
4

Table of Contents

Our student recruitment efforts are focused on three primary markets and are conducted through three admissions channels:

High School: Field-based representatives develop and maintain relationships with high school guidance counselors, teachers and administrators as well as local employers. These representatives generate student interest in pursuing a professional technician career path and our training programs through career presentations and workshops at high schools and career fairs and inviting students and their influencers on field trips and tours of our campuses and local employers’ businesses.
Adult: Campus-based representatives serve adult career-seeking or career changing students who typically inquire with our schools as a result of our advertising campaigns.
Military: Our military representatives are strategically located throughout the country. These representatives focus on building relationships with military installations in order to serve the needs of those transitioning from military service.

Affordability

We are focused on making our training more affordable and accessible through financing options, proprietary loans, institutional and relocation grants, scholarships based on need and merit, and employer sponsored training and tuition reimbursement. We assist students in applying for any grants or scholarships available for which they meet qualifications and we engage employers in developing tuition reimbursement programs for employees in good standing. During the year ended September 30, 2020, approximately 45.0% of our active students received a UTI-funded scholarship or grant and approximately 20.0% of active students received funding from our proprietary loan program. We also offer financing tools and guidance for students.

To maximize student affordability and speed to completion, we are working with high schools across the nation to increase our Technical Education Institutional Grant (“TEIG”) agreements. The TEIG agreements allow students who have completed course(s) related to their selected program of study to receive a corresponding tuition credit for up to six courses. Our students may opt out of the courses provided they pass an Advanced Placement Opportunities Test for each selected course. We have approximately 4,000 curriculum-specific TEIG agreements in place across the country; this represents approximately 14% of the high schools covered by our admissions teams. We continue to identify new opportunities to expand the volume of these curriculum-specific TEIG agreements.

In response to growing demand for trained technicians, our industry partners and employers are increasingly willing to participate in our students’ cost of education by providing them with scholarship money and relocation assistance to attend school and by offering our graduates tuition reimbursement plans and competitive compensation and benefit packages, including signing bonuses, relocation grants and tool incentives. There are over 4,600 employer location incentive opportunities, which make our training programs more affordable for students and may provide them with valuable relationships or employment opportunities following graduation.

Growth and Diversification

Over the past 10 years, we have opened three new campuses and added our welding and CNC machining programs. Our first welding program started in fiscal 2017, and we have added four additional locations at our existing campuses where the careers in the field are in demand. We are expanding our welding program to two more campuses in the next fiscal year and are evaluating additional expansion opportunities. We are intently focused on positive student graduation and employment outcomes, which are an indicator that drives student demand and ensures a high return on our students’ education investment.

Our organic growth and diversification strategy is predicated on adding new programs and new campuses in the transportation and skilled trades fields. We also have the opportunity to pursue our growth and diversification strategy through acquisitions. With a national higher-education market in transition, we are exploring potential acquisition opportunities that would allow us to enter new markets, expand our presence in existing markets, broaden our program offerings, enter into adjacent markets, or that could drive significant cost and operational synergies.

Our diversification strategy is focused on program diversification by adding new disciplines; evolving our instructional and delivery model to leverage enabling technologies and instructional strategies that drive student outcomes and allow the business to more effectively scale; and identifying and adding new ways for programs to be funded by and for students.
5

Table of Contents

Schools and Programs
Through our campus-based school system, we offer specialized technical education programs under the UTI, MMI and NASCAR Tech brands. The majority of our programs are designed to be completed in 36 to 90 weeks and culminate in a certificate, diploma or associate of occupational studies degree, depending on the program and campus. Tuition rates vary by type and length of our programs and the program level, such as core or advanced training. During the year ended September 30, 2020, tuition ranged from approximately $19,000 for our CNC program (lasting 36 weeks) to $58,000 for our Automotive and Diesel program with one specialized elective program (lasting 90 weeks). During the year ended September 30, 2020, the average annual revenue per student was approximately $28,750, net of scholarships or grants funded by us.

Our schools and programs are summarized in the following table:
Location Brand Year Campus Opened Principal Programs
Arizona (Avondale) UTI 1965 Automotive; Diesel; Welding
Arizona (Phoenix) MMI 1973 Motorcycle
California (Long Beach) UTI 2015 Automotive; Diesel; Collision Repair and Refinishing; Welding
California (Rancho Cucamonga) UTI 1998 Automotive; Diesel; Welding
California (Sacramento) UTI 2005
Automotive; Diesel; Collision Repair and Refinishing(1)
Florida (Orlando) UTI/MMI 1986 Automotive; Diesel; Motorcycle; Marine
Illinois (Lisle) UTI 1988
Automotive; Diesel; Welding(2)
New Jersey (Bloomfield) UTI 2018 Automotive; Diesel
North Carolina (Mooresville) NASCAR Tech 2002 Automotive; NASCAR; CNC Machining
Pennsylvania (Exton) UTI 2004 Automotive; Diesel
Texas (Dallas/Ft. Worth) UTI 2010 Automotive; Diesel; Welding
Texas (Houston) UTI 1983 Automotive; Diesel; Collision Repair and Refinishing; Welding
(1) This program is no longer enrolling new students. The teach-out of currently enrolled students will be completed during the first quarter of fiscal 2022.
(2) Program is eligible for enrollment with programs starting during the second quarter of fiscal 2021.

Description of Current Programs Offered
As previously noted, due to the COVID-19 pandemic during 2020, we have transitioned our on-campus, in-person education model to a blended training model that combines instructor-facilitated online teaching and demonstrations with hands-on lab training. On-campus labs have been redesigned to meet the health, safety and social distancing guidelines imposed by the CDC and state and local jurisdictions, while still meeting our accreditation and curriculum requirements. The new blended learning model not only increases access for students, but will also better prepare them to be life-long learners as technicians today perform many day-to-day tasks and continuing education courses online or on a digital device.
While the majority of our training programs have historically been completed in-person, the blended learning model is not a totally new concept for the business. In fiscal 2010, we began delivering some of our Automotive, Diesel, and Automotive/Diesel programs in blended learning format which combined daily in-person instructor-led theory, hands-on lab training, and integrated instructor-led online learning. This foundation enabled us to quickly pivot when our campus locations were forced to temporarily close due to the COVID-19 pandemic.
6

Table of Contents
Our program offerings are further described in the table below:
Program Year Established Program Focus Job Placement
Automotive 1965 Diagnose, service and repair automobiles Entry-level service technicians in automotive dealer service departments or automotive repair facilities
Diesel 1968 Diagnose, service and repair diesel systems and industrial equipment Entry-level service technicians in medium and heavy truck facilities, truck dealerships, or in service and repair facilities
Automotive/Diesel 1970 Diagnose, service and repair automobiles and diesel systems Entry-level service technicians in automotive repair facilities, automotive dealer service departments, diesel engine repair facilities, medium and heavy truck facilities, truck dealerships, or in service and repair facilities
Motorcycle 1973
Diagnose, service and repair motorcycles and all-terrain vehicles
Entry-level service technicians in motorcycle dealerships and independent repair facilities
Marine 1991
Diagnose, service and repair boats
Entry-level service technicians for marine dealerships and independent repair shops, as well as for marinas, boat yards and yacht clubs
Collision Repair and Refinishing 1999
How to repair non-structural and structural automobile damage as well as how to prepare cost estimates on all phases of repair and refinishing
Entry-level technicians at OEM dealerships and independent repair facilities
NASCAR 2002
Automotive training along with additional NASCAR-specific elective courses
Entry-level service technicians in automotive repair facilities or automotive dealer service departments, or opportunities in racing-related industries
Welding 2017
How to weld various materials using a wide range of welding processes
Entry-level welders in the construction, structural, pipe, mechanical contracting and fabrication industries.
CNC Machining 2017
How to produce precision parts used in high-performance engines and a wide variety of trucks, motorcycles, cars and boats, and also in industrial applications, aerospace components and medical and surgical equipment
Entry-level CNC operators in the manufacturing and mechanical fabrication industries
Manufacturer Specific Advanced Training (“MSAT”) Programs
In addition to the program offerings noted above, we also offer advanced training programs in the form of manufacturer-paid post-graduate MSAT programs and in the form of student-paid MSAT courses, which may be added as electives to a student’s core automotive, diesel or motorcycle program.

Manufacturer-Paid MSATs

A select number of students are offered manufacturer-paid MSATs, which are paid for by the manufacturer and/or its dealers in return for a commitment by the student to work for a dealer of that manufacturer for a certain period of time upon completion of the program. Students who are high performing graduates of an automotive or diesel program may apply to be selected for these programs. The programs range from 12 to 23 weeks in duration. Our manufacturer-paid MSATs are intended to offer in-depth instruction on specific manufacturers’ products, qualifying a graduate for employment with a dealer seeking highly specialized, entry-level technicians with brand-specific skills.
7

Table of Contents
We currently offer the following manufacturer-paid MSAT programs using vehicles, equipment, specialty tools and curricula provided by our manufacturer brand partners:
Manufacturer-Paid MSAT Programs Offered Location
BMW Service Technician Education Program (STEP) Avondale, Orlando
Mercedes-Benz DRIVE Mercedes-Benz facilities in Long Beach, California, Jacksonville, Florida, Robbinsville, New Jersey and Grapevine, Texas
Peterbilt Technician Institute Lisle, Dallas/Ft. Worth
Porsche Technician Apprenticeship Program (PTAP) Porsche facilities in Eastvale, California, Atlanta, Georgia, and Easton, Pennsylvania
Volvo Service Automotive Factory Education (SAFE) Avondale

Student-Paid MSATs

We currently offer the following student-paid MSAT programs using vehicles, equipment, specialty tools and curricula provided by and/or developed in collaboration with our manufacturer brand partners:

Student-Paid MSAT Programs Offered Location
UTI and NASCAR Tech Campuses
Cummins Engines Avondale, Exton, Houston
Cummins Power Generation Avondale
Daimler Trucks Finish First Program Avondale, Lisle
Ford Accelerated Credential Training (FACT) Avondale, Rancho Cucamonga, Sacramento, Orlando, Lisle, Mooresville, Bloomfield, Exton, Houston
General Motors Technician Career Training Avondale
Mopar TEC by Fiat Chrysler Automobiles US LLC Mooresville
Nissan Automotive Technician Training (NATT) Long Beach, Orlando, Moorseville, Houston
Toyota Professional Automotive Technician (TPAT) Sacramento, Lisle
MMI Campuses
American Honda Motor Company, Inc. Phoenix, Orlando
BMW Motorrad of North America, LLC Phoenix, Orlando
Harley-Davidson Motor Company Phoenix, Orlando
Kawasaki Motors Corporation, U.S.A Phoenix, Orlando
Mercury Marine Orlando
Suzuki Motor of America, Inc. Phoenix, Orlando
Volvo Penta of the Americas Orlando
Yamaha Motor Corporation, USA Phoenix, Orlando

Military Base Programs

In addition to the MSATs noted above, in partnership with the military and select industry partners, we have been developing and implementing advanced training programs at select military base locations. Military base programs differ from our traditional MSATs in that the students do not complete our traditional core programs at a UTI campus before entering these advanced training programs. These programs range from 12 to 16 weeks and are available to all men and women transitioning out of the military. Candidates are interviewed and selected for these programs. Additionally, to be considered, candidates must be within six months of their separation dates from the military. There is no tuition cost to the participating
8

Table of Contents
service members. We currently offer the following military base programs using vehicles, equipment, specialty tools and curricula provided by and/or developed in collaboration with certain manufacturer brand partners:
Military Base Programs Offered Location
BMW Military Service Technician Education Program Marine Corps Base Camp Pendleton in California
Penske Premier Truck Group Technician Skills Program Fort Bliss in El Paso, Texas
Student Enrollment
We enroll students throughout the year, and courses start every three to six weeks. For the year ended September 30, 2020, our average full-time enrollment was 10,462, representing a decrease of approximately 2.0% as compared to 10,674 for the year ended September 30, 2019. At September 30, 2020, our ending full-time enrollment was 12,524, an increase of 1.3% from our ending full-time enrollment of 12,363 at September 30, 2019.

Currently, our student body is geographically diverse. While our campus locations attract local students that live within 50 miles, we estimate that 50% of our students elect to relocate to attend our programs. Due to the seasonality of our business and normal fluctuations in student populations, we expect variability in our quarterly results. See "Seasonality" within Part II, Item 7 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K for further discussion of seasonal fluctuations in our revenues and operating results.

Graduate Employment
Identifying employment opportunities and preparing our graduates for their future careers is critical to our ability to deliver value to our graduates from their education.  Accordingly, we dedicate significant resources to maintaining an effective employment team. Our campus-based staff facilitates several career development processes, including instruction and coaching for interview skills, interview etiquette and professionalism. Additionally, the employment team provides students with reference materials and assistance with the composition of resumes. Finally, we place emphasis on and devote significant time to assisting students with part-time and graduate job searches.

We also have a centralized department whose focus is to build and maintain relationships with potential and existing national employers and develop graduate job opportunities and, where possible, relocation assistance, sign-on bonuses, tool packages and tuition reimbursement plans with our manufacturer brand partners and other industry employers. Together, the campuses and centralized department coordinate and host career fairs, industry awareness presentations, interview days and employer visits to our campus locations. We believe that our graduate employment services provide our students with a compelling value proposition and enhance the employment opportunities for our graduates and are a competitive differentiator from other education institutions.

Our employment rate for 2019 and 2018 graduates who were employed within one year of graduation was 84% and 86%, respectively. The employment calculation is based on all graduates, including those that completed MSAT programs, from October 1, 2018 to September 30, 2019 and October 1, 2017 to September 30, 2018, respectively, excluding graduates not available for employment because of continuing education, military service, medical reasons, incarceration, death or international student status. We count a graduate as employed based on a verified understanding of the graduate’s job duties to assess and confirm that the graduate’s primary job responsibilities are in his or her field of study. We verify employment by sending written verification requests to the graduate and/or the employer. The verifications must include employer name, job duties, job title, hire date and employer contact. Once we receive written verification from either source, the graduate is classified as employed in field as long as all verification requirements are met. In instances where we are unable to obtain written verification, we also classify graduates as employed in field if we are able to obtain verbal verification, collecting the same information as noted above, from both the graduate and the employer. We periodically review a sample of employment verifications to ensure accuracy.

9

Table of Contents
The table below summarizes the graduate employment rate data:

Year Ended September 30,
2019 2018
Graduate employment rate 84  % 86  %
Graduates 8,482  8,117 
Graduates available for employment 8,065  7,709 
Graduates employed 6,763  6,664 

Competition
The for-profit, postsecondary education industry is highly competitive and highly fragmented, with no one provider controlling significant market share. We compete with other institutions that are eligible to receive Title IV funding, including not-for-profit public and private schools, community colleges and for-profit institutions which offer automotive, diesel, collision repair, motorcycle, marine, welding, CNC machining and closely related skilled trades training programs. Our competition differs in each market depending on the curriculum we offer and the availability of other choices, including job prospects. Other competitive factors that influence our ability to attract new students include the employment market, community colleges, other career-oriented and technical schools, and the military.

Prospective students may choose to forego additional education and enter the workforce directly, especially during periods when the unemployment rate declines or remains stable as it has in recent years. This may include employment with our industry partners or with other manufacturers and employers of our graduates. We compete with local community colleges for students seeking programs that are similar to ours, mainly due to local accessibility, low tuition rates and in certain cases free tuition. Public institutions are generally able to charge lower tuition than our schools, due in part to government subsidies and other financial sources not available to for-profit schools. No single community college is a significant competitor; rather, the sector as a whole provides competition.

Within the for-profit career-oriented and technical school sector, some of our national and regional competitors are Lincoln Technical Institute, Tulsa Welding School and University of Northwestern Ohio. We also consider other single location institutions with a larger local presence near one of our campuses to be competitors. Competition is generally based on location, tuition rates, the type of programs offered, the quality of instruction and instructional facilities, graduate employment rates, reputation and recruiting. Additionally, the military often recruits or retains potential students when branches of the military offer enlistment or re-enlistment bonuses.

Human Capital Management

As of September 30, 2020, we had approximately 1,575 full-time employees, including approximately 550 instructors, 300 admissions representatives, and 420 student support employees.

Each of our employees plays a key role in our mission to provide industry-leading postsecondary education for students seeking careers as professional technicians. We believe that diversity and inclusion among our employees is essential in this process, as a truly innovative educational institution relies on a wealth of backgrounds and experiences to enhance student outcomes. To attract a truly diverse workforce, we strive to instill a culture where employees are encouraged to draw upon their own unique skills and perspectives when engaging with our growing and diverse student population.

Faculty members are hired nationally in accordance with established criteria, applicable accreditation standards and applicable state regulations. Members of our faculty are primarily industry professionals and are hired based on their prior work and educational experience. We require a specific level of industry experience in order to enhance the quality of the programs we offer and to address current and industry-specific issues in our course content. We provide intensive instructional training and continuing education to our faculty members to maintain the quality of instruction in all fields of study. A majority of our existing instructors have a minimum of five years’ experience in the industry and an average of five years of experience teaching at UTI. Our average student-to-teacher ratio during fiscal 2020 was approximately 18-to-1.
10

Table of Contents
This ratio decreased as compared to the prior year due to lower lab densities to meet the health, safety and social distancing guidelines imposed by the CDC due to COVID-19.

We employ field, military and campus-based admissions representatives who work directly with prospective students to facilitate the enrollment process. Additionally, each school has a support team that typically includes a campus president, an education director, a financial aid director, a student services director, an employment services director and a controller.

We believe our management team has the experience necessary to effectively implement our growth strategy and continue to drive positive educational and employment outcomes for our students. For discussion of the risks relating to the attraction and retention of management and executive management employees, see Item 1A. “ Risk Factors.”

Environmental Matters
We use hazardous materials at our training facilities and campuses and generate small quantities of regulated waste, including, but not limited to, used oil, antifreeze, transmission fluid, paint, solvents and car batteries. As a result, our facilities and operations are subject to a variety of environmental laws and regulations governing, among other things, the use, storage and disposal of solid and hazardous substances and waste, and the clean-up of contamination at our facilities or off-site locations to which we send or have sent waste for disposal. Certain of our campuses are required to obtain permits for our air emissions. In the event we do not maintain compliance with any of these laws and regulations, or if we are responsible for a spill or release of hazardous materials, we could incur significant costs for clean-up, damages, and fines or penalties.

Regulatory Environment

Our institutions are subject to extensive regulatory requirements imposed by a wide range of federal and state agencies, as well as by institutional and programmatic accreditors. These regulatory requirements cover the vast majority of our operations, including our educational programs, facilities, instructional and administrative staff, administrative procedures, marketing, recruiting, financial operations and financial condition. These regulatory requirements also affect our ability to acquire, expand or open additional institutions or campuses, add new, or expand our existing educational programs and change our corporate structure and ownership.

The approvals granted by these entities permit our schools to operate and to participate in a variety of government-sponsored financial aid programs that assist students in paying for their education. This includes the federal programs of student financial assistance under Title IV of the HEA, commonly referred to as Title IV Programs. We also are subject to oversight by other federal agencies including the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau (“CFPB”), the SEC, the Federal Trade Commission, the Internal Revenue Service and the Departments of Veterans Affairs, Defense, Treasury, Labor and Justice. Below, we discuss certain elements of this regulatory environment.

State Authorization

To operate and offer postsecondary programs, and to be certified to participate in Title IV Programs, each of our institutions must obtain and maintain authorization from the state in which it is physically located (“Home State”). To engage in recruiting activities outside of its Home State, each institution also may be required to obtain and maintain authorization from the states in which it is recruiting students. Each of our institutions holds the state authorizations required to operate and offer postsecondary education programs in its Home State, and to recruit in the states in which it engages in recruiting activities.

The level of regulatory oversight varies substantially from state to state and is extensive in some states. State laws may establish standards for instruction, qualifications of faculty, location and nature of facilities and equipment, administrative procedures, marketing, recruiting, student outcomes reporting, disclosure obligations to students, limitations on mandatory arbitration clauses in enrollment agreements, financial operations, and other operational matters. Some states prescribe standards of financial responsibility and mandate that institutions post surety bonds. Many states have requirements for institutions to disclose institutional data to current and prospective students, as well as to the public, and some states require that our schools meet prescribed performance standards as a condition of continued approval. States can and often do revisit, revise, and expand their regulations governing postsecondary education and recruiting.

11

Table of Contents
Accreditation

Accreditation is a non-governmental process through which an institution voluntarily submits to ongoing qualitative reviews by an organization of peer institutions. Institutional accreditation by an ED-recognized accreditor is required for an institution to be certified to participate in Title IV Programs. All of our institutions are accredited by the ACCSC, which is an accrediting agency recognized by ED.

ACCSC reviews the academic quality of each institution’s instructional programs, as well as the administrative and financial operations of the institution to ensure that it has the resources necessary to perform its educational mission, implement continuous improvement processes, and support student success. Our institutions must submit annual reports, and at times, supplemental reports, to demonstrate ongoing compliance and improvement. ACCSC requires institutions to disclose certain institutional information to current and prospective students, as well as to the public, and requires that our schools and programs meet various performance standards as a condition of continued accreditation. ACCSC often revisits, revises, and expands its standards and policies. Institutions must periodically renew their accreditation by completing a comprehensive renewal of accreditation process.

We strive to maintain the highest standards. For 2020, of the approximately 650 schools accredited with ACCSC, 26 schools were awarded with the School of Excellence or Distinction status, of which five were UTI or MMI campuses. Currently 11 of our campuses are classified as a School of Excellence or Distinction. Six of our campuses have achieved this award twice in their history, and one campus has received this award three times in its history.

The table below sets out the renewal cycle for each of our schools.
Campus Accreditation Expiration Renewal Status On-Site Evaluation
Long Beach, California September 2022 Renewed March 2017
Exton, Pennsylvania(1)
October 2022 Renewed June 2016
Dallas/Ft. Worth, Texas(1)
March 2023 Renewed December 2016
Sacramento, California(1)
December 2023 Renewed March 2017
Mooresville, North Carolina; NASCAR Technical Institute (NASCAR Tech)(1)
December 2024 Renewed July 2018
Avondale, Arizona(1)
February 2025 Renewed February 2019
Orlando, Florida(1)
February 2025 Renewed August 2018
Houston, Texas(1)
February 2025 Renewed September 2018
Lisle, Illinois(1)
February 2025 Renewed December 2018
Rancho Cucamonga, California(1)
February 2025 Renewed March 2019
Phoenix, Arizona; Motorcycle Mechanics Institute (MMI)(1)
May 2025 Renewed April 2019
Bloomfield, New Jersey(2)
May 2025 Renewed December 2019

(1) Indicates a school that has achieved School of Excellence status during its most recent renewal of accreditation, which recognizes ACCSC-accredited institutions for their commitment to the expectations and rigors of ACCSC accreditation, as well as the efforts made by the institution in maintaining high levels of achievement among their students.

(2) Indicates a school that has achieved School of Distinction status during its most recent renewal of accreditation, which recognizes accredited member schools that demonstrated a commitment to the expectations and rigors of ACCSC accreditation, as well as a commitment to delivering quality educational programs to students.

Title IV Programs

The federal government provides a substantial part of its support for postsecondary education through Title IV Programs in the form of grants and loans to students who can use those funds at any institution that has been certified as eligible to participate by ED. All of our institutions are certified to participate in Title IV Programs. In fiscal 2020, we derived approximately 66% of our revenues, on a cash basis as defined by ED, from Title IV Programs. We derived approximately 48% of our revenues, on a cash basis, from the Direct Loan program, pursuant to which ED makes loans to students or their parents. We derived approximately 18% of our revenues, on a cash basis, from the Pell program, pursuant to which ED
12

Table of Contents
makes grants to students who demonstrate financial need. And we derived less than 1% of our revenues, on a cash basis, from the Federal Supplemental Educational Opportunity Grant (“FSEOG”) program. FSEOG grants are designed to supplement Pell grants for students with the greatest financial need. Institutions must provide matching funding equal to 25% of all awards made under this program.

The Title IV Program statutes and regulations are applied primarily on an institutional basis. The HEA defines an “institution” as a main campus and its additional locations. Pursuant to this definition, ED recognizes us as operating three institutions, organized as follows:

Institution: Universal Technical Institute of Arizona
Main campus: Universal Technical Institute, Avondale, Arizona
Additional campuses: Universal Technical Institute, Lisle, Illinois
Universal Technical Institute, Long Beach, California
Universal Technical Institute, Rancho Cucamonga, California
NASCAR Technical Institute, Mooresville, North Carolina
Institution: Universal Technical Institute of Phoenix
Main campus: Universal Technical Institute DBA Motorcycle Mechanics Institute, Motorcycle & Marine Mechanics Institute, Phoenix, Arizona
Additional campuses: Universal Technical Institute, Sacramento, California
Universal Technical Institute, Orlando, Florida for the following divisions:
Motorcycle Mechanics Institute, Orlando, Florida
Marine Mechanics Institute, Orlando, Florida
Automotive, Orlando, Florida
Institution: Universal Technical Institute of Texas
Main campus: Universal Technical Institute, Houston, Texas
Additional campuses: Universal Technical Institute, Exton, Pennsylvania
Universal Technical Institute, Dallas/Ft. Worth, Texas
Universal Technical Institute, Bloomfield, New Jersey

To participate in Title IV Programs, an institution must be authorized by the relevant state, accredited by an ED-recognized accreditor, and certified by ED. To obtain and maintain certification, institutions also must demonstrate ongoing compliance with the HEA and its extensive and complex implementing regulations; regulations that ED frequently revisits, revises, and expands. Because all of our institutions are certified to participate in Title IV Programs, they all must comply with this complex framework of statutes, regulations, and guidance, and undergo detailed oversight and review. Below, we discuss the core components of the Title IV Programs’ regulatory framework.

Eligibility and Recertification

All institutions participating in the Title IV Programs must first establish their eligibility to do so. The Program Participation Agreement (“PPA”) document serves as ED’s formal recognition that an institution and its associated additional locations have satisfied this requirement, and are authorized to participate in Title IV Programs for a specified period of time. An institution seeking to expand its activities in certain ways, such as opening an additional location or raising the highest academic credential it offers, must obtain approval from ED. Every institution also is required to periodically renew its certification by applying for continued certification before its current term of certification expires. Terms of certification are typically six years, but can be three years or shorter. We received a fully recertified PPA for Universal Technical Institute of Texas in April 2018, which will expire March 31, 2022. In November 2018, we received a fully recertified PPA for Universal Technical Institute of Arizona and a fully recertified PPA for Universal Technical Institute of Phoenix. Both of the PPA’s will expire on March 31, 2022.
13

Table of Contents
The 90/10 Rule

As a condition of participation in Title IV Programs, proprietary institutions must agree when they sign their PPA to derive at least 10% of their revenues for each fiscal year from sources other than Title IV Program funds. A proprietary institution loses its eligibility to participate in Title IV Programs if it derives more than 90% of its revenue from Title IV Programs for two consecutive fiscal years as calculated under a complex, cash basis formula mandated by ED. The loss of such eligibility would begin on the first day following the conclusion of the second consecutive year in which the institution exceeded the 90% limit and, as such, any Title IV Program funds already received by the institution and its students during a period of ineligibility would have to be returned to ED or a lender, if applicable. Additionally, if an institution exceeds the 90% level for a single year, ED will place the institution on provisional certification for a period of at least two years, could impose other restrictions or conditions on the institution’s Title IV eligibility, and, under ED’s current financial responsibility regulations, could conclude that the institution lacks financial responsibility and is required to submit a letter of credit or other form of financial protection.

As of September 30, 2020, our institutions’ annual Title IV percentages as calculated under the 90/10 rule ranged from approximately 65% to 68%. We regularly monitor compliance with this requirement to minimize the risk that any of our institutions would derive more than the allowable maximum percentage of its revenue from Title IV Programs for any fiscal year.

Administrative Capability

To continue its participation in Title IV Programs, an institution must demonstrate that it remains administratively capable of providing the education it promises and of properly managing the Title IV Programs. ED assesses the administrative capability of each institution that participates in Title IV Programs under a series of standards listed in the regulations, which cover a wide range of operational and administrative topics, including the designation of capable and qualified individuals, the quality and scope of written procedures, the adequacy of institutional communication and processes, the timely resolution of issues, the sufficiency of recordkeeping, and the frequency of findings of noncompliance, to name a few. ED’s administrative capability standards also include thresholds and expectations for federal student loan cohort default rates (discussed below), satisfactory academic progress, and loan counseling. Failure to satisfy any of the standards may lead ED to find the institution ineligible to participate in Title IV Programs, require the institution to repay Title IV Program funds, change the method of payment of Title IV Program funds, or place the institution on provisional certification as a condition of its continued participation or take other actions against the institution.

Three-Year Student Loan Default Rates

To remain eligible to participate in Title IV Programs, institutions also must maintain federal student loan cohort default rates below specified levels. ED calculates an institution’s cohort default rate on an annual basis. Under the current calculation, the cohort default rate is derived from student borrowers who first enter loan repayment during a federal fiscal year (“FFY”) ending September 30 and subsequently default on those loans within the two following years; parent borrowers are excluded from the calculation. This represents a three-year measuring period. The following tables set forth the most recent three-year cohort default rates for our institutions:

Three-Year Cohort Default Rates for
Cohort Years Ended September 30, (1)
Institution: 2017 2016 2015
Universal Technical Institute of Arizona 13.8% 14.8% 14.9%
Universal Technical Institute of Phoenix 14.0% 14.4% 15.0%
Universal Technical Institute of Texas 16.1% 15.0% 17.4%
All proprietary postsecondary institutions (2)
14.7% 15.2% 15.6%
(1)Based on information published by ED.
(2)Includes other proprietary institutions beyond Universal Technical Institute.

14

Table of Contents
An institution whose cohort default rate exceeds 30% in consecutive fiscal years may be subject to conditions and restrictions, and will lose eligibility if the rate remains above 30% three years in a row. An institution also will lose eligibility if its rate exceeds 40% for any fiscal year. As demonstrated in the table above, none of our institutions had a three-year cohort default rate of 30% or greater for 2017, 2016 or 2015, for the three most recent FFYs with published rates. An institution whose three-year cohort default rate is 15% or greater for any one of the three preceding years is subject to a 30-day delay in receiving the first disbursement on federal student loans for first-time borrowers. As of September 30, 2020, only Universal Technical Institute of Texas was subject to a 30-day delay in receiving the first disbursement on federal student loans for first-time borrowers due to a three-year cohort default rate that was 15% or greater for one of the three most recent years. The 30-day delay was lifted as of September 30, 2020 for Universal Technical Institute of Phoenix due to the three-year cohort default rate falling below 15%.

Financial Responsibility

All institutions participating in Title IV Programs also must satisfy specific ED standards of financial responsibility. Among other things, an institution must meet all of its financial obligations, including required refunds to students and any Title IV Program liabilities and debts, be current in its debt payments, comply with certain past performance requirements, not receive an adverse, qualified, or disclaimed opinion by its accountants in its audited financial statements. Each year, ED also evaluates institutions’ financial responsibility by calculating a “composite score,” which utilizes information provided in the institutions’ annual audited financial statements. The composite score is based on three ratios: (1) the equity ratio which measures the institution’s capital resources, ability to borrow and financial viability; (2) the primary reserve ratio which measures the institution’s ability to support current operations from expendable resources; and (3) the net income ratio which measures the institution’s ability to operate at a profit.

ED assigns a strength factor to the results of each of these ratios on a scale from negative 1.0 to positive 3.0, with negative 1.0 reflecting financial weakness and positive 3.0 reflecting financial strength. ED then assigns a weighting percentage to each ratio and adds the weighted scores for the three ratios together to produce a composite score for the institution. If an institution’s composite score is above 1.5, and it meets all other requirements, it is deemed financially responsible. If its composite score is below 1.5, but at least 1.0, the institution is still considered to be financially responsible, but must agree to additional oversight by ED in the form of cash monitoring and other participation requirements.

If an institution’s composite score is below 1.0, the institution is considered by ED to lack financial responsibility. ED may permit the institution to continue to participate in the Title IV Programs if it agrees to, among other things: (1) post a letter of credit in an amount equal to at least 50% of the total Title IV Program funds received by the institution during its most recently completed fiscal year; or (2) post a letter of credit in an amount equal to at least 10% of such prior year’s Title IV Program funds, accept provisional certification for a period of no more than three years, comply with additional ED notification and operating requirements and conditions, and agree to receive Title IV Program funds under an arrangement other than ED’s standard advance funding arrangement. If an institution is unable to establish financial responsibility on an alternative basis, the institution may be subject to financial penalties, restrictions on operations and loss of external financial aid funding.

ED has historically evaluated the financial condition of our institutions on a consolidated basis based on the financial statements of Universal Technical Institute, Inc. as the parent company. ED’s regulations permit ED to examine the financial statements of Universal Technical Institute, Inc., the financial statements of each institution and the financial statements of any related party. ED has not required us currently to post a letter of credit on behalf of any of our schools. ED has required us to provide certain information on a regular basis following our issuance of preferred stock on July 15, 2016, and we continue to provide monthly reports to ED pursuant to such direction. For our year ended September 30, 2020, we calculated our composite score to be 2.3. However, the composite score calculations and resulting requirements imposed on our institutions are subject to determination by ED once it receives and reviews our audited financial statements.

Between composite score calculations, ED also will reevaluate the financial responsibility of an institution following the occurrence of certain “triggering events,” which must be timely reported to the agency. Specifically, ED may determine that an institution is not able to meet its financial or administrative obligations if one of the following events occurs:

The institution incurs a liability from a settlement, final judgment or final determination arising from an administrative or judicial action or proceeding initiated by a federal or state entity and, as a result of that liability, the institution’s recalculated composite score is less than 1.0 as determined by ED under procedures described in the regulations;
15

Table of Contents
For a proprietary institution whose composite score is less than 1.5, there is a withdrawal of owner’s equity from the institution by any means (as defined by the regulations) and, as a result of that withdrawal, the institution’s recalculated composite score is less than 1.0 as determined by ED under procedures described in the regulations;
The SEC issues an order suspending or revoking the registration of the institution’s securities or suspends trading of the institution’s securities on any national securities exchange;
The national securities exchange on which the institution’s securities are traded notifies the institution that it is not in compliance with the exchange’s listing requirements and, as a result, the institution’s securities are delisted;
The SEC is not in timely receipt of a required report and did not issue an extension to file the report; or
If two or more “discretionary” triggering events (as described below) take place within a certain time period unless a triggering event is resolved before any subsequent event(s) occurs.

ED also may determine that an institution is not able to meet its financial or administrative obligations if one of the following discretionary triggering events occurs and is likely to have a material adverse effect on the financial condition of the institution:

The accrediting agency for the institution issued an order, such as a show cause order or similar action, that, if not satisfied, could result in the withdrawal, revocation or suspension of institutional accreditation;
The institution violated a provision or requirement in a security or loan agreement and a default, delinquency or other event occurs that triggers or enables the creditor to require or impose on the institution an increase in collateral, a change in contractual obligations, an increase in interest rates or payments, or other sanctions, penalties, or fees;
The institution’s state licensing agency notifies the institution of an intent to withdraw or terminate the institution’s state licensure if the institution does not take the steps necessary to come into compliance with a state licensing agency requirement;
The institution did not receive at least 10 percent of its revenue from non-Title IV sources for its most recently completed fiscal year as calculated by ED;
The institution has high annual drop-out rates as calculated by ED; or
The institution’s two most recent official cohort default rates are 30 percent or greater, as determined under the regulations and unless the institution has a pending or successful appeal that sufficiently reduces at least one of the rates.

ED regulations give the institution an opportunity to provide information to the agency demonstrating that the triggering event is not material to the institution’s financial position in advance of any final determination regarding the institution’s financially responsibility.

Substantial Misrepresentation

The regulatory definitions of “misrepresentation” and “substantial misrepresentation” enforced by ED are exceptionally broad and do not require intent by the institution to misrepresent, or actual reliance by the person to whom the alleged misrepresentation was made. Therefore, it is possible that a statement made by the institution or one of its service providers or representatives could be construed by ED to constitute a substantial misrepresentation, even if the statement was made in error, without intent to misrepresent, and the person to whom it was made did not actually rely upon it.

Incentive Compensation

The “incentive compensation” prohibition forbids institutions from providing any commission, bonus, or other incentive payment based in any part, directly or indirectly, on success in securing enrollments or the award of financial aid to any person or entity engaged in any student recruiting or admission activities or in making decisions regarding the awarding of Title IV Program funds. We have made adjustments to the compensation practices for our admissions representatives which we believe comply with the current regulations and ED’s guidance. We will continue to evaluate other compensation options under these regulations and guidance.
16

Table of Contents

Title IV Program Rulemaking

ED is almost continuously engaged in one or more negotiated rulemakings, which is the process pursuant to which it revisits, revises, and expands the complex and voluminous Title IV Program regulations. Recent and significant negotiated rulemakings are discussed below.

Borrower Defense to Repayment Rulemaking

The Obama administration carried out a negotiated rulemaking in 2016 to significantly revise and enhance the borrower defense to repayment (“BDTR”) framework, which specifies in regulation which acts or omissions of an institution of higher education a borrower may assert as a defense to repayment of Title IV Program loans. Dissatisfied with the results of the 2016 effort (the “2016 BDTR Rule”), the Trump administration held a second negotiated rulemaking in 2018 to revise the BDTR rule yet again, and published its own final rule on September 23, 2019 (the “2019 BDTR Rule”), which became effective on July 1, 2020.

Litigation and regulatory actions caused considerable confusion regarding the effective date for each version of the BDTR rule, and how and when each will be interpreted and applied. Institutions of higher education are required to comply (and to have complied) with the 2016 BDTR Rule from July 1, 2017 to June 30, 2020, and to comply with the 2019 BDTR Rule from July 1, 2020 forward. Because the 2016 BDTR Rule was not deemed “good law” until October 2018, institutions also are required to follow nuanced guidance from ED regarding compliance during the period prior to the Court’s decisions, but subsequent to July 1, 2017. Finally, when promulgating the 2019 BDTR Rule, ED determined that some elements of the 2016 BDTR Rule would continue to be applied on a go-forward basis, if the underlying events that gave rise to the issue occurred prior to the implementation of the 2019 BDTR Rule. As such, elements of the 2016 BDTR Rule will remain in place, coexisting with the 2019 BDTR Rule and being applied by ED in specified circumstances.

While the borrower defense claim process was (and is) at the heart of the BDTR rulemaking, the regulatory reforms carried out by the rule are far more extensive. In 2016, and then again in 2018, the BDTR rule included material changes to the regulations governing financial responsibility, closed school discharge, false certification discharge, misrepresentation, student grievance processes, the reporting of litigation and arbitration proceedings, the use of pre-dispute arbitration agreements and class action waivers in agreements with students, and the publication of repayment rates. Additional details regarding certain of these reforms are as follows:

The Borrower Defense Claim Process. The BDTR rules establish amended procedures and standards for borrowers, either individually or as a group, to assert through an ED-administered process a defense to the borrowers’ obligation to repay certain Title IV Program loans based on certain acts or omissions of the institution. The 2016 BDTR Rule details the types of defenses available for loans first disbursed between July 1, 2017 and June 30, 2020. The 2019 BDTR Rule details the types of defenses available for loans first disbursed on or after July 1, 2020. If ED approves a borrower’s defense to repayment through the applicable administrative process established in the proposed regulations, ED may discharge the borrower’s obligation to repay some or all of the borrower’s student loans and may initiate a separate proceeding to collect from the institution the discharged and returned amounts.

Financial Responsibility. The 2016 BDTR Rule significantly revised ED’s financial responsibility framework to specify certain triggering events, and to require that they be timely reported to ED. It was believed that these new requirements would permit ED to identify, as early as possible, events that might impact an institution’s financial health. The 2019 BDTR Rule does not abandon the revised financial responsibility framework established by the 2016 BDTR Rule, both triggering events and reporting timeframes remain. However, the 2019 BDTR Rule meaningfully simplifies the reporting requirements, and affords institutions additional opportunity to dialogue with ED regarding the materiality of a reported event.

Pre-Dispute Contractual Provisions. The 2016 BDTR Rule prohibited the use and reliance upon certain contractual provisions regarding dispute resolution processes, such as pre-dispute arbitration agreements or class action waivers, and required certain notifications, contract provisions, and disclosures by institutions regarding students’ ability to participate in class action lawsuits or to initiate certain lawsuits instead of through arbitration. The rules also required institutions to submit to ED copies of certain records in connection with any claim filed in arbitration by or against the school concerning a borrower defense claim and any claim filed in a lawsuit by the school against the student or by any party against the school concerning a borrower defense claim. The 2019 BDTR Rule, which took
17

Table of Contents
effect on July 1, 2020, generally permits the use of arbitration clauses and class action waivers provided institutions make certain disclosures to students. The litigation and regulatory actions that impacted the effective date for each version of the BDTR rule have made it extremely difficult to predict when and how the ban on these pre-dispute contractual provisions will be interpreted and applied by courts, particularly to litigation that precedes or spans the effective dates of the BDTR rules.

Closed School Loan Discharge. ED regulations have long provided that ED may discharge a borrower’s obligation to repay certain Title IV Program loans if the borrower (or the student on whose behalf a parent borrowed) did not complete the program of study for which the loan was made because the campus at which the borrower (or student) was enrolled closed. If ED discharges the loans, the agency may seek to recover from the school or other related parties the amount of loans discharged and to impose other liabilities and penalties. Consequently, if we close a campus, ED could discharge borrower obligations to repay certain Title IV Program loans. We may be able to mitigate these losses by conducting or arranging for an orderly teach-out of students at a closed campus, but these efforts could be unsuccessful if students decline to participate in the teach-out or transfer their credits to another school or if they fail to complete their programs. The 2019 BDTR Rule revised the closed school loan discharge regulations to allows students to obtain a discharge if, among other requirements, they were enrolled not more than 180 days before the campus closed. ED has the authority to extend the 180-day period for extenuating circumstances. ED also has the authority to discharge on its own initiative the loans of qualified borrowers without a borrower application if the borrower did not subsequently re-enroll in any Title IV eligible institution within three years from the date the school closed. The 2019 BDTR Rule limits this authority to schools that closed between November 1, 2013 and July 1, 2020. If we were to close a campus, we would intend to teach-out all of the currently enrolled students at the campus. However, certain students may elect to withdraw before graduation. We cannot predict the number of students who might withdraw prior to the closure of a campus and potentially qualify for a loan discharge.

Accreditation and Innovation Rulemaking

On October 15, 2018, ED announced its intent to establish a negotiated rulemaking to develop regulations related to several matters, including, but not limited to, requirements for accrediting agencies in their oversight of member institutions and programs; criteria used by ED to recognize accrediting agencies; simplification of ED’s recognition and review of accrediting agencies; clarification of the core oversight responsibilities amongst accrediting agencies, states and ED; clarification of the permissible arrangements between an institution of higher education and another organization to provide a portion of an educational program; roles and responsibilities of institutions and accrediting agencies in the teach-out process; regulatory changes required to ensure equitable treatment of brick-and-mortar and distance education programs; regulatory changes required to enable expansion of direct assessment programs, distance education, and competency-based education; regulatory changes required to clarify disclosure and other requirements of state authorization; emphasizing the importance of institutional mission in evaluating its policies, programs and outcomes; simplification of state authorization requirements related to distance education; defining “regular and substantive interaction” as it relates to distance education and correspondence courses; defining the term “credit hour;” defining the requirements related to the length of educational programs and entry level requirements for the occupation; and other matters.

In early 2019, ED hosted multiple rounds of negotiated rulemaking. The committee and subcommittees completed their meetings in April 2019 and reached consensus on draft proposed regulations. On November 1, 2019, ED published its final rule covering accreditation and state authorization matters, with a general effective date of July 1, 2020. On September 2, 2020, ED published its final rule covering distance education and innovation matters, with a general effective date of July 1, 2021.

Gainful Employment Rulemaking

ED’s gainful employment regulations that took effect July 1, 2015, included debt-to-earning metrics and disclosure requirements that applied to all programs offered by proprietary institutions. Programs with debt-to-earnings that failed to satisfy certain thresholds could lose Title IV Program eligibility. On July 1, 2019, following a contentious negotiated rulemaking, ED issued final regulations that rescinded the existing gainful employment regulations, effective July 1, 2020. However, a future administration could seek to reinstate the gainful employment rule, or some version of it.

18

Table of Contents
Other Federal and State Student Aid Programs

Some of our students also receive financial aid from federal sources other than Title IV Programs, such as the programs administered by the VA, the U.S. Department of Defense (“DOD”) and under the Workforce Investment Act. Additionally, some states provide financial aid to our students in the form of grants, loans or scholarships. Our Long Beach, Rancho Cucamonga and Sacramento, California campuses, for example, are currently eligible to participate in the Cal Grant program. All of our institutions must comply with the eligibility and participation requirements applicable to each of these funding programs, which vary by funding agency and program.

In 2020 we derived approximately 17% of our revenues, on a cash basis, from veterans’ benefits programs, which include the Post-9/11 GI Bill, the Montgomery GI Bill, the Reserve Education Assistance Program (“REAP”) and VA Vocational Rehabilitation. To continue participation in veterans’ benefits programs, an institution must comply with certain requirements established by the VA, including that the institution report on the enrollment status of eligible students; maintain student records and make such records available for inspection; follow rules applicable to the individual benefits programs; and comply with applicable limits on the percentage of students receiving certain veterans’ benefits on a program and campus basis.

The VA shares responsibility for VA benefit approval and oversight with designated State Approving Agencies (“SAAs”). SAAs play a critical role in evaluating institutions and their programs to determine if they meet VA benefit eligibility requirements. Processes and approval criteria, as well as interpretation of applicable requirements, can vary from state to state. Therefore, approval in one state does not necessarily result in approval in all states.

The VA imposes limitations on the percentage of students per program receiving benefits under certain veterans’ benefits programs, unless the program qualifies for certain exemptions. If the VA determines that a program is out of compliance with these limitations, the VA will continue to provide benefits to current students, but new students will not be eligible to use their veterans’ benefits for an affected program until we demonstrate compliance. Additionally, the VA requires a campus be in operation for two years before it can apply to participate in VA benefit programs. With the exception of our newest campus in Bloomfield, New Jersey, which opened in August 2018, all of our campuses are eligible to participate in VA education benefit programs.

During 2012, President Obama signed an Executive Order directing the DOD, Veterans Affairs and Education to establish “Principles of Excellence” (“Principles”), based on certain guidelines set forth in the Executive Order, to apply to educational institutions receiving federal funding for service members, veterans and family members. As requested, we provided written confirmation of our intent to comply with the Principles to the VA in June 2012. We are required to comply with the Principles to continue recruitment activities on military installations. Additionally, there is a requirement to possess a memorandum of understanding (“MOU”) with the DOD as well as with certain individual installations. Our access to bases for student recruitment has become more limited due to recent changes in the Transition Assistance Program (Transition Goals, Plans, Success) and increased enforcement of the MOU requirement. Each of our institutions has an MOU with the DOD. We have MOUs with certain key individual installations and are pursuing MOUs at additional locations; however, some installations will not provide MOUs to institutions that do not teach at the installation. We continue to strengthen and develop relationships with our existing contacts and with new contacts in order to maintain and rebuild our access to military installations.

Available Information
Our Annual Report on Form 10-K, Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q, Current Reports on Form 8-K and amendments to those reports filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Exchange Act are available free of charge on our website at www.uti.edu under the “Investor Relations - Financial Information - SEC Filings” captions, as soon as reasonably practicable after we electronically file such material with, or furnish it to, the SEC. Reports of our executive officers, directors and any other persons required to file securities ownership reports under Section 16(a) of the Exchange Act are also available through our website. Information contained on our website is not a part of this Annual Report on Form 10-K and is not incorporated herein by reference.


19


ITEM 1A. RISK FACTORS

We provide the following cautionary discussion of risks, uncertainties and possibly inaccurate assumptions relevant to our business. These are factors that, individually or in the aggregate, could cause our actual results to differ materially from expected and historical results. We note these factors for investors within the meaning of Section 21E of the Exchange Act and Section 27A of the Securities Act. You should understand that it is not possible to predict or identify all such factors. Consequently, you should not consider the following to be a complete discussion of all potential risks or uncertainties. You should consider carefully the risks and uncertainties described below in addition to other information contained in this Annual Report on Form 10-K, including our consolidated financial statements and related notes.

Risks Related to the Extensive Regulation of Our Business

Failure of our schools to comply with the extensive regulatory requirements for school operations could result in financial requirements or penalties, restrictions on our operations and loss of external financial aid funding.

As detailed in “Business - Regulatory Environment,” our institutions are subject to extensive regulatory requirements imposed by a wide range of federal and state agencies, as well as by our institutional accreditor. These requirements, which are frequently being revisited, revised, and expanded, cover virtually every aspect of our schools’ operations. The approvals granted by these entities permit our schools to operate and to participate in a variety of government-sponsored financial aid programs, including Title IV Programs, from which we derived approximately 66% of our revenues, on a cash basis, in fiscal year 2020. If our institutions fail to comply with any of these regulatory requirements, our regulators could take an array of adverse actions, including, without limitation, revocation of the approval granted by the agency. Any such adverse action could adversely affect our cash flows, results of operations and financial condition, and impose significant operating restrictions upon us. We cannot predict with certainty how all of these regulatory requirements will be applied or whether each of our schools will be able to comply with all of the requirements in the future.

Failure to maintain eligibility to participate in Title IV Programs could materially and adversely affect our business.

We cannot predict how Title IV Program requirements described in “Business - Regulatory Environment-Title IV Programs” will change in the future or be interpreted. Additionally, given the complex nature of the regulations and the fact that they are subject to interpretation, it is reasonable to conclude that in the conduct of our business, we may inadvertently violate such regulations. In the event of a violation, ED could impose sanctions or limitations, or terminate an institution’s Title IV Program eligibility. Types of sanctions or limitations ED might impose include, without limitation: requiring the repayment of Title IV Program funds; imposing a less favorable payment system for the institution’s receipt of Title IV Program funds; placing an institution on provisional certification status; commencing a proceeding to impose a fine or to limit, suspend, or terminate the institution’s participation in Title IV Programs; or declining to renew the institution’s program participation agreement. Such sanctions or limitations, or the loss of Title IV Program eligibility by any of our current or future institutions, could have a material adverse effect on our academic or operational initiatives, cash flows, results of operations, or financial condition.

Forms of noncompliance that could result in sanctions or limitations, or cause the institution to lose its eligibility to participate in some or all Title IV Programs, include, without limitation: a failure to maintain the state authorizations described in “Business - Regulatory Environment-State Authorization”; a failure to maintain the institutional accreditation described in “Business - Regulatory Environment-Accreditation”; a failure to satisfy the administrative capability standards discussed in “Business - Regulatory Environment-Administrative Capability”; a failure to satisfy the loan default rate thresholds discussed in “Business - Regulatory Environment-Three Year Student Loan Default Rates”; a failure to satisfy the loan default rate thresholds discussed in “Business - Regulatory Environment-Perkins Loan Default Rates”; a failure to correctly calculate and timely return unearned Title IV Program funds received for students who withdraw before completing their educational programs; a failure to correctly determine whether students are making satisfactory academic progress in their programs and, as such, remain eligible to receive Title IV Program funds; or a failure to satisfy the financial responsibility standards detailed in “Business - Regulatory Environment-Financial Responsibility.” Similarly, the following types of noncompliance could result in sanctions or limitations, or cause the institution to lose its eligibility to participate in some or all Title IV Programs:

90/10 Rule. A failure by one of our institutions to derive at least 10% of its revenues for each fiscal year from sources other than Title IV Program funds, as described in “Business - Regulatory Environment-The 90/10 Rule.” We also observe that multiple legislative proposals have been introduced in Congress that would impact the 90/10
20


Rule, such as reducing the 90% maximum under the rule to 85% or including military and veterans’ funding in the 90% portion of the calculation. Such statutory revisions could negatively impact our institutions’ ability to satisfy the 90/10 Rule.

Substantial Misrepresentations. A determination by ED that one or more of our institutions engaged in a substantial misrepresentation, as described in “Business - Regulatory Environment - Substantial Misrepresentations.” If ED determines that one of our institutions has engaged in substantial misrepresentation, ED may impose sanctions or other conditions upon the institution including, but not limited to, initiating an action to fine the institution or limit, suspend, or terminate its eligibility to participate in the Title IV Programs. Either ED or the person to whom the alleged misrepresentation was made also could seek to have the person’s loans discharged under the borrower defense to repayment regulations discussed below.

Incentive Compensation. A determination by ED that one or more of our institutions failed to comply with the “incentive compensation” prohibition, as described in “Business - Regulatory Environment - Incentive Compensation.” Because the current regulations differ significantly from prior regulations, and because of the imprecise nature of many aspects of these regulations and ED’s published guidance, it is not clear how ED will apply these regulations in all circumstances. For this reason, we cannot guarantee that ED will not take a position that some aspect of our compensation practices is not in compliance with these regulations.

For more information, see “Business - Regulatory Environment - Title IV Programs.”

Compliance with current and future Title IV Program regulations arising out of negotiated rulemakings could materially and adversely affect our business.

ED is almost continuously engaged in one or more negotiated rulemakings, which is the process pursuant to which it revisits, revises, and expands the complex and voluminous Title IV Program regulations. These regulations also are frequently challenged through litigation, creating significant uncertainty as to when and what part of the regulations have taken effect, how they should be implemented, and how they will be interpreted and enforced. We devote significant effort to understanding the effects of these regulations on our business and to developing compliant solutions that also are congruent with our business, culture, and mission to serve our students and industry relationships. However, we cannot predict with certainty how these new and developing regulatory requirements will be applied or whether each of our schools will be able to comply with all of the requirements in the future. Significant negotiated rulemakings that could materially and adversely affect our business are discussed in “Business - Regulatory Environment - Title IV Program Rulemaking.”

The 2019 BDTR Rule, which took effect July 1, 2020, requires institutions to report certain events to ED. One such reportable event is the closure of our Norwood, Massachusetts campus in July 2020. In May 2019, we submitted our formal notification to ED regarding the closure of the Norwood, Massachusetts campus. ED has acknowledged receipt of our notification and has not requested any further information at this time. We cannot predict the timing, content or impact of any future requests from ED, if any, related to the closure of our Norwood, Massachusetts campus. The occurrence, and notification to ED, of such actions, events, or conditions could result in ED recalculating our composite score or requiring us to submit a letter of credit in an amount to be calculated by ED and agree to other conditions on our Title IV participation, which could have a material adverse effect on our business.

The loss of funds from Veterans' benefits programs could materially and adversely affect our business.

A discussed in “Business - Regulatory Environment - Other Federal and State Student Aid Programs,” to participate in veterans’ benefits programs, including the Post-9/11 GI Bill, the Montgomery GI Bill, the REAP, and VA Vocational Rehabilitation, our institutions must comply with certain requirements applicable to these programs. If we fail to comply with these requirements, we could lose our eligibility to participate in veterans’ benefits programs, which could have a material adverse effect on our academic or operational initiatives, cash flows, results of operations, or financial condition. Specific considerations that could negatively impact the funding we receive from veterans’ benefits programs include, without limitation: (1) restricted access to military installations for student recruitment; (2) the success of federal legislative proposals that would increase the requirements of the 90/10 Rule, such as reducing the 90% maximum under the rule to 85% and/or including military and veteran funding in the 90% portion of the calculation; (3) a reduction in appropriations for veterans’ benefits programs, or an extended government shutdown; and (4) an inability to secure approvals in one or more states, delays in the process for obtaining approvals, or the revocation of an approval.

21


Congress may change the law or reduce funding for or place restrictions on the use of funds received through Title IV Programs, which could reduce our student population, revenues and/or profit margin.

Congress periodically revises the HEA and other laws, and enacts new laws, governing Title IV Programs and determining the funding level for each Title IV Program, and may make changes in the laws at any time. Congress most recently reauthorized the HEA in 2008. It is actively working on another HEA reauthorization, but it is uncertain whether and when the process will be completed. Any action by Congress that significantly reduces funding for Title IV Programs or the ability of our schools or students to receive funding through these programs or places restrictions on the use of funds received by an institution through these programs could have a material adverse effect on our academic or operational initiatives, cash flows, results of operations, or financial condition. Such action may occur during HEA reauthorization, or such action could also occur as part of separate technical amendments to the HEA or during Congress’ annual budget and appropriations cycle. These uncertainties could reduce our student population, revenues and/or profit margin.

Continued or increased examination of the for-profit education sector could result in further legislation, appropriations, regulations, and enforcement actions that could materially or adversely affect our business.

Over the last decade, Congress has focused significantly on for-profit education institutions, specifically regarding participation in Title IV Programs and DOD oversight of tuition assistance for military service members attending for-profit colleges. Continued or increased Congressional activity could result in the enactment of more stringent legislation, further rulemakings affecting participation in Title IV Programs and other governmental actions, increasing regulation of the for-profit sector. The likelihood of such activity could be increased as a result of elections and appointments. The composition of federal and state executive offices, executive agencies, and legislatures are subject to change based on the results of periodic elections, appointments, and other events. In some cases, candidates for elected positions in federal or state executive or legislative offices or for appointments to positions in federal or state agencies have negative opinions on for-profit education providers or may support initiatives such as eliminating or reducing student aid eligibility for for-profit education providers or providing funding to free or reduced tuition programs at public and other nonprofit postsecondary education institutions, which could adversely impact our ability to compete with such institutions. Action by Congress or other regulators may increase our administrative costs and require us to modify our practices in order for our institutions to comply with Title IV Program requirements. In addition, concerns generated by this Congressional activity may adversely affect enrollment in for-profit educational institutions such as ours. Any laws that are adopted that limit our or our students’ participation in Title IV Programs or in programs to provide funds for active duty service members and veterans or the amount of student financial aid for which our students are eligible, or any decreases in enrollment related to the Congressional activity concerning this sector, could have a material adverse effect on our academic or operational initiatives, cash flows, results of operations, or financial condition.

Our business could be harmed if we experience a disruption in our ability to process student loans under the Federal Direct Loan Program.

Because all Title IV Program student loans (other than Perkins loans) are now processed under the DL program, any processing disruptions by ED may impact our students’ ability to obtain student loans on a timely basis. A disruption in our ability to process student loans through the DL program, either because of administrative challenges on our part or the inability of ED to process the increased volume of loans through the DL program on a timely basis, could have a material adverse effect on our academic or operational initiatives, cash flows, results of operations, or financial condition.

Government and regulatory agencies and third parties may conduct compliance reviews, bring claims or initiate litigation against us.

Because we operate in a highly regulated industry, we are subject to compliance reviews and claims of noncompliance by government agencies, regulatory agencies and third parties alleging noncompliance with applicable standards. Each of our institutions’ administration of Title IV Program funds must be audited annually by independent accountants and the resulting audit report must be submitted to ED for review. Compliance reviews and claims could also result from our notification to an agency or third party based upon our own internal compliance review. We are also subject to various lawsuits, investigations and claims, covering a wide range of matters, including, but not limited to, alleged violations of federal and state laws, false claims made to the federal government and routine employment matters. While we are committed to strict compliance with all applicable laws, regulations, and accrediting standards, if the results of government, regulatory or third party reviews or proceedings are unfavorable to us, or if we are unable to successfully defend against lawsuits or claims, we may be required to pay monetary damages or be subject to fines, limitations, loss of regulatory approvals or Title IV Program funding or other
22


federal and state funding, injunctions or other penalties. We could also incur substantial legal costs that are not covered or are in excess of our insurance coverage. Even if we adequately address issues raised by an agency review or successfully defend a lawsuit or claim, we may have to divert significant financial and management resources from our ongoing business operations to address issues raised by those reviews or defend those lawsuits or claims. Additionally, given the significant public scrutiny being placed on the sector we operate in, numerous state attorneys general have initiated investigations either of the operation of the for-profit schools in their state or of particular institutions operating in that state. Changes occurring at the federal or state level, as well as our financial performance in recent years, may spur further action or additional reporting requirements by state attorneys general, congressional leadership or state licensing bodies.

We cannot predict the outcome of unsettled matters, and we may incur significant defense costs and other expenses in connection with them in excess of our insurance coverage related to these matters. We may be required to pay substantial damages, settlement costs or fines or penalties. Such costs and expenses could have a material adverse effect on our business, cash flows, results of operations and financial condition. An adverse outcome in any of these matters could also materially and adversely affect our licenses, accreditation and eligibility to participate in Title IV Programs.

For more information, see “Risk Factors - Risks Related to the Extensive Regulation of Our Business - Failure to maintain eligibility to participate in Title IV Programs could materially and adversely affect our business” and “Business - Regulatory Environment - Title IV Programs.”

Our business and stock price could be adversely affected as a result of regulatory investigations of, or actions commenced against, us or other companies in our industry.

The operations of companies in the education and training services industry, including us, are subject to intense regulatory scrutiny. In some cases, allegations of wrongdoing on the part of such companies have resulted in formal or informal investigations by the U.S. Department of Justice, the SEC, state governmental agencies, ED and other federal agencies. These allegations have attracted adverse media coverage and have been the subject of legislative hearings and regulatory actions at both the federal and state levels, focusing not only on the individual schools but in some cases on the for-profit postsecondary education sector as a whole. These investigations of, or regulatory actions against, specific companies in the education and training services industry could have a negative impact on our industry as a whole and on our stock price. Furthermore, the outcome of such investigations and any accompanying adverse publicity could negatively affect student enrollment and heighten the risk of class action lawsuits against us, which could have a material adverse effect on our academic or operational initiatives, cash flows, results of operations, or financial condition.

Changes in the state regulatory environment, state and agency budget constraints and increased regulatory requirements, may affect our ability to obtain and maintain necessary authorizations or approvals from those states to conduct or change our operations.

Due to state budget constraints and changes in the regulatory environment in some of the states in which we operate, it is possible that some states may reduce the number of employees in, or curtail the operations of, the state education agencies that authorize our schools. A delay or refusal by any state education agency in approving any changes in our operations that require state approval, such as the opening of a new campus, the introduction of new programs or the revision of existing programs, a change of control or the hiring or placement of new admissions representatives, could prevent us from making such changes or delay our ability to make such changes, or could require substantial additional costs to accommodate such delay.

State education agencies that authorize our schools continue to revise or issue new regulations requiring significant additional reporting and monitoring of student outcomes. Additionally, state education agencies may request additional information or supplemental reporting as a result of our recent financial performance. The regulations and reporting requirements may lengthen the time to obtain necessary state approvals and require us to modify our operations in order to comply with the requirements. This could impose substantial additional costs on our institutions, which could have a material adverse effect on our cash flows, results of operations and financial condition.

State legislatures also continue to contemplate creating new performance metrics that would have to be satisfied to maintain eligibility. The enactment of one or more of these proposed laws or similar laws could create compliance challenges and impose substantial additional costs on our institutions, which could have a material adverse effect on our academic or operational initiatives, cash flows, results of operations, or financial condition.

23


Budget constraints in states that provide state financial aid to our students could reduce the amount of such financial aid that is available to our students, which could reduce our student population and negatively affect our 90/10 Rule calculation and other compliance metrics.

Some states are facing budget constraints that are causing them to reduce state appropriations in a number of areas including financial aid provided to students that may attend one of our programs. These states may decide to reduce or redirect the amount of state financial aid that they provide to students, but we cannot predict how significant any of these reductions will be or how long they will last. If the level of state funding available to our students decreases and our students are not able to secure alternative sources of funding, it could have a material adverse effect on our academic or operational initiatives, cash flows, results of operations, or financial condition, negatively impact our cohort default rates, or impact our performance under the federal 90/10 Rule calculation, as this state funding is counted in the non-Title IV Program funds portion of the ratio.

If we acquire an institution that participates in Title IV Programs or open an additional location, one or more of our regulators could decline to approve the acquired institution or additional location, or could impose material conditions or restrictions, which could prevent or limit the ability of the acquired institution and/or additional location to participate in Title IV Programs and, in turn, impair our ability to operate the acquired institution and/or the additional location as planned or to realize the anticipated benefits from the acquisition of that institution and/or opening of the additional location.

If we acquire an institution that participates in Title IV Program funding or open an additional location, we must obtain approval from ED and applicable state education agencies and accrediting commissions in order for the institution or additional location to be able to operate and participate in Title IV Programs. Such approvals may be withheld or delayed. An acquisition can result in the temporary suspension of the acquired institution’s participation in Title IV Programs and opening an additional location can result in a delay of the campus’ participation in Title IV Programs unless we submit a timely and materially complete application for approval of the acquisition or the opening of the new location. If we were unable to timely establish or re-establish the state authorization, accreditation or ED certification of the acquired institution or obtain approval for the new location, our ability to operate the acquired institution or open the additional location as planned or to realize the anticipated benefits from the acquisition of that institution or the opening of the additional location could be significantly impaired.

Further, ED and applicable state education agencies and accrediting agencies could impose material conditions or restrictions on us and the acquired institution or the additional location, including, but not limited to, a material letter of credit, limitations or prohibitions on the ability to add new campuses or add or change educational programs, placement of the institution on the heightened cash monitoring or reimbursement method of payment and reporting and notification requirements. Additionally, an acquired institution may have known or unknown instances of noncompliance with federal, state or accrediting agency requirements, including, but not limited to, noncompliance with requirements included in the defense to repayment regulations that could result in liabilities, sanctions, or material conditions or restrictions that we may inherit by acquiring the institution. Further, our due diligence efforts relating to institutions that we intend to acquire may be unsuccessful and fail to identify noncompliance or other facts that could result in liabilities, sanctions, or material conditions or restrictions. The imposition of liabilities, sanctions, or material conditions or restrictions by one or more regulators could impair our ability to operate the acquired institution or open the additional location as planned or to realize the anticipated benefits from the acquisition of that institution or the opening of the additional location.

If regulators do not approve additional or revised programs, it could have an adverse effect on our academic or operational initiatives

A student may only use Title IV Program funds to pay the costs associated with enrollment in an eligible educational program offered by an institution participating in Title IV Programs. Our expansion plans are based, in part, on our ability to add new educational programs at our existing institutions. Generally, an institution that is eligible to participate in Title IV Programs, and is not provisionally certified, may obtain ED approval if the new program is licensed by the applicable state agency and accredited by an agency recognized by ED. However, ED, or state education agencies, and our accreditor could decline to approve a new program, or impose material conditions or restrictions on us. Any such denial or material limitation could have a material adverse effect on our academic or operational initiatives, cash flows, results of operations, or financial condition.

24


If regulators do not approve or delay their approval of transactions involving a change of control of our company or any of our schools, our ability to participate in Title IV Programs may be impaired.

If we or any of our schools experience a change of control under the standards of applicable federal and state agencies, our accrediting commission or ED, we or the affected schools must seek the approval of the relevant regulatory agencies. These agencies do not have uniform criteria for what constitutes a change of control. Transactions or events that constitute a change of control include significant acquisitions or dispositions of our common stock or significant changes in the composition of our board of directors. Some of these transactions or events may be beyond our control. Our failure to obtain, or a delay in receiving, approval of any change of control from ED, our accrediting commission or any state in which our schools are located would impair our ability to participate in Title IV Programs, which would have a material adverse effect on our academic or operational initiatives, cash flows, results of operations, or financial condition. Our failure to obtain, or a delay in obtaining, approval of any change of control from any state in which we do not have a school but in which we recruit students could require us to suspend our recruitment of students in that state until we receive the required approval. The potential adverse effects of a change of control with respect to participation in Title IV Programs could influence future decisions by us and our stockholders regarding the sale, purchase, transfer, issuance or redemption of our stock.

Risks Related to Our Business

Public health pandemics, epidemics or outbreaks could have a material adverse effect on our business and operations.

In December 2019, a novel strain of coronavirus (“COVID-19”) emerged in Wuhan, China. While initially concentrated in China, the outbreak has spread to other countries and infections have been reported globally including in the United States. The World Health Organization has declared the outbreak to be a pandemic, the United States had declared a state of national emergency, and many state and local governments are continuing to take various actions to combat the spread of the virus. The extent to which COVID-19, like any other rapidly spreading contagious illness, may impact our business and operations will depend on the evolution of the outbreak, which is highly speculative at this time and cannot be predicted with any level of certainty. The duration of the outbreak, new information which emerges concerning the severity of the illness and the actions to be taken to contain the spread of COVID-19 or its treatment remains unclear. We believe that the continued spread of COVID-19 could adversely impact our business and operations. In addition, a quarantine of one or more of our faculty members for two or more weeks due to exposure to COVID-19 or other contagious illness could eliminate a program unless a substitute was readily available and quarantine of a faculty member or student could cause the temporary closure of an affected campus which could have an adverse impact on our business and our financial results. Further, workforce limitations and travel restrictions resulting from pandemics or disease outbreaks and related government actions may impact many aspects of our business. If a significant percentage of our workforce is unable to work, including because of illness or travel or government restrictions in connection with pandemics or disease outbreaks, our operations and enrollment may be negatively impacted. Finally, state and federal regulators, including the ED, are augmenting existing regulatory processes, waiving others, and overseeing various emergency relief and aid programs. It is highly uncertain how long such regulatory accommodations will continue, or how long and in what amount emergency relief and aid funds will continue to be available. We also cannot predict the types of conditions that may be attached to participation in emergency relief and aid programs, and whether and to what extent compliance with such conditions will be monitored and enforced.

On March 19, 2020, we suspended all in-person classes at all of our campuses for the safety and protection of our students and staff, to help slow the spread of COVID-19 and to comply with state and local orders and restrictions. Upon the suspension of all in-person classes, we provided all students with the opportunity to take a leave of absence or to continue their education via an online curriculum. On March 25, 2020, we began offering the classroom portion of our training online so that the more than 8,000 students who elected to remain active in the program could continue their education remotely. As our training is a combination of classroom lectures and hands-on labs, there is a portion of most classes that cannot be delivered online and needs to be completed in-person at the campus labs.

We transitioned our on-campus, in-person education model to a blended training model that combines instructor-facilitated online teaching and demonstrations with hands-on labs. On-campus labs have been redesigned to meet the health, safety and social distancing guidelines imposed by the CDC and state and local jurisdictions, while still meeting our accreditation and curriculum requirements. In May 2020, we resumed in-person labs at eight of our campus locations. Four of our campuses resumed in-person labs in June 2020, and our final campus in Bloomfield, New Jersey resumed in-person labs on July 1, 2020.

25


Once a student returns to campus for in-person labs, under the new guidelines it takes on average approximately six to nine weeks for that student to catch-up on the lab work that he was unable to complete during the campus closure and prior to his return. Additionally, some students have not returned to campus to complete the in-person labs and remain only in the online portion of the curriculum, essentially only completing half of each course, while others are completing catch-up labs, but over an extended period of time. We continue to recognize revenue ratably over the term of the course or program offered, taking into consideration those only completing the online curriculum, and the catch-up period for active students and the impact it has on expected graduation dates. As a result, as of September 30, 2020, we deferred revenue of $6.1 million.

While we have reopened all of our campus locations, some students have delayed returning to campus for in-person labs even with the new social distancing protocols in place and remain on leave of absence or continue only with the online instruction portion of the curriculum. If students continue to remain on a leave of absence, withdraw, or do not make up the required in person labs on a timely basis, our revenues could continue to be impacted in fiscal 2021.

Macroeconomic conditions and aversion to debt could adversely affect our business.

We believe that our enrollment is affected by changes in economic conditions, although the nature and magnitude of this effect are uncertain and may change over time. Enrollment tends to be counter cyclical, and the strength or weakness of the economy directly impacts us. During periods when the unemployment rate declines or remains stable, prospective students have more employment options and recruiting new students has traditionally been more challenging. Affordability concerns associated with increased living expenses, relocation expenses and the availability of full- and part-time jobs for students attending classes have made it more challenging for us to attract and retain students.

Conversely, an increase in the unemployment rate and weaker macroeconomic conditions could reduce the willingness of employers to sponsor educational opportunities for their employees and affect the ability of our students to find employment in the industries that we serve, any of which could have a material adverse effect on our cash flows, results of operations and financial condition.

Adverse market conditions for consumer and federally guaranteed student loans could negatively impact the ability of borrowers with little or poor credit history, such as many of our students, to borrow the necessary funds at an acceptable interest rate. These events could adversely affect the ability or willingness of our former students to repay student loans, which could increase our student loan cohort default rate and require increased time, attention and resources to manage these defaults.

Competition could decrease our market share and create tuition pricing concerns.

The postsecondary education market is highly competitive. We continue to experience a high level of competition for higher quality students not only from similar programs, but also from the overall employment market and the military. Some traditional public and private colleges and universities and community colleges, as well as other private career-oriented schools, offer programs that may be perceived by students to be similar to ours. We compete with local community colleges for students seeking programs that are similar to ours, mainly due to local accessibility, low tuition rates and in certain cases free tuition. Most public institutions are able to charge lower tuition than our schools, due in part to government subsidies and other financial sources not available to for-profit schools.

Prospective students may choose to forego additional education and enter the workforce directly, especially during periods when the unemployment rate declines or remains stable as it has in recent years. This may include employment with our industry partners or with other manufacturers and employers of our graduates. Additionally, the military often recruits or retains potential students when branches of the military offer enlistment or re-enlistment bonuses.

We may limit tuition increases or increase spending in response to competition in order to retain or attract students or pursue new market opportunities; however, if we cannot effectively respond to competitor changes, it could reduce our enrollments and our student populations. We cannot be sure that we will be able to compete successfully against current or future competitors or that competitive pressures faced by us will not adversely affect our market share, revenues and operating margin.

26


Our financial performance depends in part on our ability to continue to develop awareness and acceptance of our programs among high school graduates, military personnel and adults seeking advanced training.

The awareness of our programs among high school graduates, military personnel and working adults seeking advanced training is critical to the continued acceptance and growth of our programs. Our inability to continue to develop awareness of our programs could reduce our enrollments, which could have a material adverse effect on our cash flows, results of operations and financial condition. The following are some of the factors that could prevent us from successfully marketing our programs:

availability of funding sources acceptable to our students;
recruitment of veterans or other potential students without formal education by our industry partners and other manufacturers;
our failure to maintain or expand our brand or other factors related to our marketing or advertising practices;
diminished access to high school student populations, including school district limitations on access to students by for-profit institutions;
reduced access to military bases and installations;
our inability to maintain relationships with automotive, diesel, collision repair, motorcycle and marine manufacturers and suppliers; and
student dissatisfaction with our programs and services.

Failure on our part to maintain and expand existing industry relationships and develop new industry relationships with our industry customers could impair our ability to attract and retain students.

We have extensive industry relationships that we believe afford us significant competitive strength and support our market leadership. These relationships enable us to support enrollment in our core programs by attracting students through brand name recognition and the associated prospect of high-quality employment opportunities. Additionally, these relationships allow us to diversify funding sources, expand the scope and increase the number of programs we offer and reduce our costs and capital expenditures due to the fact that, pursuant to the terms of the underlying contracts with manufacturer brand partners, we provide a variety of specialized training programs and typically do so using tools, equipment and vehicles provided by the manufacturer brand partners. These relationships also provide additional incremental revenue opportunities from training the employees of our industry customers. Our success depends in part on our ability to maintain and expand our existing industry relationships and to enter into new industry relationships. Certain of our existing industry relationships, including those with American Honda Motor Company, Inc.; Mercury Marine, a division of Brunswick Corporation; Volvo Penta of the Americas, Inc. and Yamaha Motor Corporation, USA, are not memorialized in writing and are based on verbal understandings. As a result, the rights of the parties under these arrangements are less clearly defined than they would be had they been in writing. Additionally, certain of our written agreements may be terminated without cause by the OEM. Finally, certain of our existing industry relationship agreements expire within the next six months. We are currently negotiating to renew these agreements and intend to renew them to the extent we can do so on satisfactory terms. The reduction or elimination of, or failure to renew any of our existing industry relationships, or our failure to enter into new industry relationships, could impair our ability to attract and retain students, require additional capital expenditures or increase expenses and have a material adverse effect on our cash flows, results of operations and financial condition.

Our success depends in part on our ability to update and expand the content of existing programs and develop and integrate new programs in a cost-effective manner and on a timely basis.

Prospective employers of our graduates demand that their entry-level employees possess appropriate technological skills. These skills are becoming more sophisticated in line with technological advancements in the automotive, diesel, collision repair, motorcycle and marine industries. Accordingly, educational programs at our schools must keep pace with those technological advancements. Additionally, the method used to deliver curriculum has evolved to include online delivery. The updates to our existing programs and the development of new programs, and changes in the method in which we deliver them, may not be accepted by our students, prospective employers or the technical education market. Even if we are able to develop acceptable new programs, we may not be able to introduce these new programs as quickly as the industries we serve require or as quickly as our competitors. If we are unable to adequately respond to changes in market requirements due to unusually rapid technological changes or other factors, our ability to attract and retain students could be impaired and our graduate employment rates could suffer.

27


Additionally, if we are unable to address and respond to requirements for new or updated curricula such as training instructors to teach the curricula, obtaining the appropriate equipment to teach the curricula to our students, or obtaining the appropriate regulatory approvals, we may not be able to successfully roll out the curricula to our campuses in a timely and cost-effective manner. If we are not able to effectively and efficiently integrate curricula, this could have a material adverse effect on our cash flows, results of operations and financial condition.

Growing our online academic programs could be difficult for us.

The expansion of our existing online programs and the creation of new online programs may not be accepted by students or employers, or by government regulators or accreditation agencies. In addition, our efforts may be materially adversely affected by increased competition in the online education market or because of problems with the performance or reliability of our online program infrastructure. There is also increasing development of online programs by traditional universities, both in the public and private sectors, which may have more consumer acceptance than programs we develop because of lower pricing or perception of greater value of their degrees in the marketplace, which may materially adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We are heavily dependent on the reliability and performance of an internally developed student management and reporting system, and any difficulties in maintaining this system may result in service interruptions, decreased customer service or increased expenditures.

The software that underlies our student management and reporting has been developed primarily by our own employees. The reliability and continuous availability of this internal system and related integrations are critical to our business. Any interruptions that hinder our ability to timely deliver our services, or that materially impact the efficiency or cost with which we provide these services, or our ability to attract and retain computer programmers with knowledge of the appropriate computer programming language, would adversely affect our reputation and profitability and our ability to conduct business and prepare financial reports. Additionally, many of the software systems we currently use will need to be enhanced over time or replaced with equivalent commercial products, either of which could entail considerable effort and expense.

System disruptions and security threats to our computer networks, including breach of the personal information we collect, could have a material adverse effect on our business and our reputation.

Our computer systems as well as those of our service providers are vulnerable to interruption, malfunction or damage due to events beyond our control, including malicious human acts committed by foreign or domestic persons, natural disasters, and network and communications failures. We have established a written data breach incident response policy, which we test informally and formally at least annually. Additionally, we periodically perform vulnerability self-assessments and engage service providers to perform independent vulnerability assessments and penetration tests. However, despite network security measures, our servers and the servers at our service providers are potentially vulnerable to physical or electronic unauthorized access, computer hackers, computer viruses, malicious code, organized cyber attacks and other security problems and system disruptions. Increasing socioeconomic and political instability in some countries has heightened these risks. Despite the precautions we and our service providers have taken, our systems may still be vulnerable to these threats. A user who circumvents security measures could misappropriate proprietary information or cause interruptions or malfunctions in operations.

Additionally, the personal information that we collect subjects us to additional risks and costs that could harm our business and our reputation. We collect, retain and use personal information regarding our students and their families and our employees, including personally identifiable information, tax return information, financial data, bank account information and other data. Although we employ various network and business security measures to limit access to and use of such personal information, we cannot guarantee that a third party will not circumvent such security measures, resulting in the breach, loss or theft of the personal information of our students and their families and our employees. Possession and use of personal information in our operations also subjects us to legislative and regulatory burdens that could restrict our use of personal information and require notification of data breaches. A violation of any laws or regulations relating to the collection, retention or use of personal information could also result in the imposition of fines or lawsuits against us.

Sustained or repeated system failures or security breaches that interrupt our ability to process information in a timely manner or that result in a breach of proprietary or personal information could have a material adverse effect on our operations and our reputation. Although we maintain insurance in respect of these types of events, available insurance proceeds may not be adequate to compensate us for damages sustained due to these events.
28



We may not be able to retain our key personnel or hire and retain the personnel we need to sustain and grow our business.

Our success to date has depended, and will continue to depend, largely on the skills, efforts and motivation of our executive officers who generally have significant experience with our company and within the technical education industry. Our success also depends in large part upon our ability to attract and retain highly qualified faculty, campus presidents, administrators and corporate management. Due to the nature of our business and our operating results in recent years, we face significant competition in the attraction and retention of personnel who possess the skill sets that we seek. The for-profit education sector is under significant regulatory and government scrutiny, which may make it more difficult to attract and retain talent. If we are unable to, or are perceived to be unable to, attract and retain experienced and qualified personnel, our business, financial condition and results of operations may be materially adversely affected. Additionally, key personnel may leave us and subsequently compete against us. Because we do not currently carry “key man” life insurance, the loss of the services of any of our key personnel, or our failure to attract and retain other qualified and experienced personnel on acceptable terms, could impair our ability to successfully manage our business.

If we are unable to hire, retain and continue to develop and train our admissions representatives, the effectiveness of our student recruiting efforts would be adversely affected.

In order to support revenue growth and student enrollment, we need to hire and train new admissions representatives, as well as retain and continue to develop our existing admissions representatives, who are our employees dedicated to student recruitment. Our ability to develop a strong admissions representative team may be affected by a number of factors, including the following:

the competition we face from other companies in hiring;
consumer trends causing certain sectors (other than for-profit, postsecondary education) to experience significant growth in less regulated environments with the potential to offer higher compensation;
our ability to compensate admissions representatives while remaining compliant with ED regulations related to incentive compensation;
our ability to assimilate and motivate our admissions representatives;
our ability to effectively train our admissions representatives;
the length of time it takes new admissions representatives to become productive; and
our ability to effectively manage a multi-location educational organization.

If we are unable to hire, develop or retain quality admissions representatives, the effectiveness of our student recruiting efforts would be adversely affected.

If we fail to improve our underutilized capacity, we may experience a deterioration of our profitability and operating margins.

We have underutilized capacity at a number of our campuses. Our ongoing efforts to fill or reduce existing capacity may strain our management, operations, employees or other resources. We may not be able to maintain our current capacity utilization rates, effectively manage our operations or achieve planned capacity utilization on a timely or profitable basis. If we are unable to improve our underutilized capacity, we may experience operating inefficiencies at a level that would result in higher than anticipated costs, which would adversely affect our profitability and operating margins.

Our success depends, in part, on the effectiveness of our marketing and advertising programs in recruiting new students.

In order to maintain and increase our revenues and margins, we must continue to develop our admissions programs and attract new students in a cost-effective manner. The level of marketing and advertising and types of strategies used are affected by the specific geographic markets, regulatory compliance requirements and the specific individual nature of each institution and its students. The complexity of these marketing efforts contributes to their cost. If we are unable to advertise and market our institutions and programs successfully, our ability to attract and enroll new students could be materially adversely affected and, consequently, our financial performance could suffer. We use marketing tools such as the Internet, radio, television and print media advertising to promote our institutions and programs. Our representatives also make presentations at high schools and career fairs. Additionally, we rely on the general reputation of our institutions and referrals from current students, alumni and employers as a source of new enrollment. As part of our marketing and advertising, we also subscribe to lead-generating databases in certain markets, the cost of which may increase. Among the factors that could
29


prevent us from marketing and advertising our institutions and programs successfully are the failure of our marketing tools and strategies to appeal to prospective students, regulatory constraints on marketing, current student and/or employer dissatisfaction with our program offerings or results and diminished access to high school campuses and military bases. In order to maintain our growth, we will need to attract a larger percentage of students in existing markets and increase our addressable market by adding locations in new markets and rolling out new academic programs. Any failure to accomplish this may have a material adverse effect on our future growth.

Failure on our part to effectively identify, establish and operate additional schools or campuses could reduce our ability to implement our growth strategy.

As part of our business strategy, we anticipate opening and operating new schools or campuses. Establishing new schools or campuses poses unique challenges and requires us to make investments in management and capital expenditures, incur marketing expenses and devote other resources that are different, and in some cases greater, than those required with respect to the operation of acquired schools. Accordingly, when we open new schools, initial investments could reduce our profitability. To open a new school or campus, we would be required to obtain appropriate state and accrediting commission approvals, which may be conditioned or delayed in a manner that could significantly affect our growth plans. Additionally, to be eligible for Title IV Program funding, a new school or campus would have to be certified by ED. We cannot be sure that we will be able to identify suitable expansion opportunities to maintain or accelerate our current growth rate or that we will be able to successfully integrate or profitably operate any new schools or campuses. Our failure to effectively identify, establish, license, accredit, obtain necessary approvals and manage the operations of newly established schools or campuses could slow our growth and make any newly established schools or campuses more costly to operate than we have historically experienced.

We may be unable to successfully complete or integrate future acquisitions.

We may consider selective acquisitions in the future. We may not be able to complete any acquisitions on favorable terms or, even if we do, we may not be able to successfully integrate the acquired businesses into our business. Integration challenges include, among others, regulatory approvals, significant capital expenditures, assumption of known and unknown liabilities, our ability to control costs and our ability to integrate new personnel. The successful integration of future acquisitions may also require substantial attention from our senior management and the senior management of the acquired schools, which could decrease the time that they devote to the day-to-day management of our business. If we do not successfully address risks and challenges associated with acquisitions, including integration, future acquisitions could harm, rather than enhance, our operating performance. Additionally, if we consummate an acquisition, our capitalization and results of operations may change significantly. A future acquisition could result in the incurrence of debt and contingent liabilities, an increase in interest expense, amortization expenses, goodwill and other intangible assets, charges relating to integration costs or an increase in the number of shares outstanding. In addition, our acquisition of a school is a change of ownership of that school, which may result in the temporary suspension of that school’s participation in federal student financial aid programs until it obtains ED’s approval. These results could have a material adverse effect on our cash flows, results of operations and financial condition or result in dilution to current stockholders.

Our proprietary loan program could have a negative effect on our results of operations.

Our proprietary loan program enables students who have utilized all available government-sponsored or other financial aid and have not been successful in obtaining private loans from other financial institutions, for independent students, or PLUS loans, for dependent students, to borrow a portion of their tuition if they meet certain criteria.

Under our proprietary loan program, the bank originates loans for our students who meet our specific credit criteria with the related proceeds to be used exclusively to fund a portion of their tuition. We then purchase all such loans from the bank at least monthly and assume all the related credit and collection risk. See Note 2 of the notes to our Consolidated Financial Statements within Part II. Item 8 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K for further discussion of activity under our proprietary loan program.

Factors that may impact our ability to collect these loans include the following, without limitation: current economic conditions; compliance with laws applicable to the origination, servicing and collection of loans; the quality of our loan servicers’ performance; and a decline in graduate employment opportunities and the priority that the borrowers under this loan program attach to repaying these loans as compared to other obligations, particularly students who did not complete or were dissatisfied with their programs of study.
30



The portion of a student's tuition revenue related to the proprietary loan program is considered a form of variable consideration. We estimate the amount we ultimately expect to collect from the portion of tuition that is funded by the proprietary loan program, resulting in a note receivable. The estimated amount is determined at the inception of the contract, and we recognize the related revenue as the student progresses through school. Each reporting period, we update our assessment of the variable consideration associated with the proprietary loan program. Estimating the collection rate requires significant management judgment. If we are unable to accurately assess the variable consideration, our revenues and profitability may be adversely impacted.

Federal, state and local laws and general legal and equitable principles relating to the protection of consumers can apply to the origination, servicing and collection of the loans under our proprietary loan program. Any violation of various federal, state or local laws, including, in some instances, violations of these laws by parties not under our control, may result in losses on the loans or may limit our ability to collect all or part of the principal or interest on the loans. This may be the case even if we are not directly responsible for the violations by such parties.

Our proprietary loan program may also be subject to oversight by the CFPB, which could result in additional reporting requirements or increased scrutiny. Other proprietary postsecondary institutions have been subject to information requests from the CFPB with regard to their private student loan programs. The possibility of litigation, and the associated cost, are risks associated with our proprietary loan program. At least two proprietary education institutions have been subject to lawsuits under the Consumer Financial Protection Act of 2010; the institutions are accused of having unfair private student loan programs and of allegedly engaging in certain abusive practices, including interfering with students' ability to understand their debt obligations and failing to provide certain material information.

Changes in laws or public policy could negatively impact the viability of our proprietary loan program and cause us to delay or suspend the program. Additionally, depending on the terms of the loans, state consumer credit regulators may assert that our activities in connection with our proprietary loan program require us to obtain one or more licenses, registrations or other forms of regulatory approvals, any of which may not be able to be obtained in a timely manner, if at all. All of these factors could result in our proprietary loan program having a material adverse effect on our cash flows, results of operations and financial condition.

We rely on third parties to originate, process and service loans under our proprietary loan program. If these companies fail or discontinue providing such services, our business could be harmed.

A state chartered bank with a small market capitalization originates loans under our proprietary loan program. If the bank no longer provides service under the contract, we do not currently have an alternative bank to fulfill the demand. There are a limited number of banks that are willing to participate in a program such as our proprietary loan program. The time it could take us to replace the bank could result in an interruption in the loan origination process, which could result in a decrease in our student populations. Furthermore, a single company processes loan applications and services the loans under our proprietary loan program. There is a 90-day termination clause in the contract under which they provide these services. If this company were to terminate the contract, we could experience an interruption in loan application processing or loan servicing, which could result in a decrease in our student populations.

We have goodwill, which may become impaired and subject to a write-down.

Goodwill represents the excess of the cost of an acquired business over the estimated fair values of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed. Goodwill is reviewed at least annually for impairment, which might result from the deterioration in the operating performance of acquired businesses, adverse market conditions, adverse changes in applicable laws or regulations and a variety of other circumstances. Any resulting impairment charge is recognized as an expense in the period in which impairment is identified. Our total recorded goodwill of $8.2 million as of September 30, 2020 relates to our MMI Orlando, Florida campus and resulted from the acquisition of our motorcycle and marine education business in 1998. We perform our annual goodwill impairment assessment during the fourth quarter of each fiscal year. Future assessments of goodwill could result in reductions. Any reduction in net income and operating income resulting from the write-down or impairment of goodwill could adversely affect our financial results. If economic or industry conditions deteriorate or if market valuations decline, including with respect to our common stock, we may be required to impair goodwill in future periods.

31


Risks Related to Investing in Our Common Stock

Holders of our Series A Preferred Stock own a significant percentage of our capital stock, are able to influence and control certain corporate matters and could in the future substantially dilute the ownership interest of holders of our common stock.

On June 24, 2016, we entered into a purchase agreement (the “Coliseum Securities Purchase Agreement”) pursuant to which we sold 700,000 shares of Series A Preferred Stock to Coliseum Holdings I, LLC (“Coliseum Holdings”), and filed a Certificate of Designation, Preferences and Rights of Series A Convertible Preferred Stock (the “Certificate of Designations”) with the Secretary of State of the State of Delaware. The Certificate of Designations authorized a total of 700,000 shares of Series A Preferred Stock, all of which were purchased by Coliseum Holdings, and set forth the negotiated rights, powers, preferences and privileges of the Series A Preferred Stock, including the terms of a Conversion Cap and an Investor Voting Cap (each as defined in the Certificate of Designations), which generally prohibit: (i) the conversion of Series A Preferred Stock into common stock; and (ii) the voting of common stock issuable upon conversion of the Series A Preferred Stock, to the extent that such conversion results in the issuance of a number of shares of common stock exceeding 4.99% of our outstanding shares of common stock as of June 24, 2016 or that has voting power that exceeds 4.99% of the voting power of our outstanding shares of common stock as of June 24, 2016.

The Certificate of Designations provides that the Conversion Cap and the Investor Voting Cap may only be removed upon our receipt of: (i) certain stockholder approvals required by Section 312.03 of the New York Stock Exchange Listed Company Manual (“NYSE Rule 312”); and (ii) either (A) Education Regulatory Approval (as defined in the Certificate of Designations), or (B) a good faith determination by our board of directors that Education Regulatory Approval is not required. Our stockholders approved a proposal at the annual meeting of stockholders on February 27, 2020, in accordance with the listing standards of the New York Stock Exchange (“NYSE”), that satisfied NYSE Rule 312.

In September 2020, Coliseum Holdings distributed all of its 700,000 shares of Series A Preferred Stock to its members, who subsequently distributed their shares to (i) limited partners affiliated with Coliseum Holdings and certain other entities for whom Coliseum Capital Management, LLC (an affiliate of Coliseum Holdings) holds voting and dispositive power with respect to the Series A Preferred Stock (the “Affiliated Holders”), which Affiliated Holders, following such distribution, owned Series A Preferred Stock that represented, on an as converted basis, approximately 24.9% of our outstanding shares of common stock and voting power, and (ii) limited partners unaffiliated with Coliseum Holdings (the “Unaffiliated Holders”), which Unaffiliated Holders, following such distribution, each owned shares of Series A Preferred Stock that represented, on an as converted basis, 9.9% or less of our outstanding shares of common stock and voting power (collectively, the “Distributions”).

In connection with the Distributions, our board of directors made a good faith determination that: (i) no Education Regulatory Approval would be required for the Unaffiliated Holders to remove the Conversion Cap and the Investor Voting Cap with respect to the Series A Preferred Stock acquired in the Distributions; and (ii) as to the Series A Preferred Stock held by the Affiliated Holders, no Education Regulatory Approval would be required prior to the Affiliated Holders (A) converting a number of shares of Series A Preferred Stock into common stock provided that the number of shares of common stock issued pursuant to such conversion, in the aggregate, is less than or equal to 9.9% of the number of shares of common stock outstanding on an as converted basis as of the date of the Distributions, and (B) voting a number of shares of Series A Preferred Stock provided that the voting power of such Series A Preferred Stock and any shares of common stock issued upon conversion of such Series A Preferred Stock is less than or equal to 9.9% of the voting power of the common stock outstanding as of the date of the Distributions (the foregoing limitations, the “Continuing Caps”).

In September 2020, the Distributions were completed and the removal of the Conversion Cap and Investor Voting Cap became effective, subject to the Continuing Caps remaining in place with respect to the Series A Preferred Stock distributed to the Affiliated Holders. Education Regulatory Approval continues to be required for, and the Continuing Caps will remain in place with respect to, the Series A Preferred Stock acquired by the Affiliated Holders in the Distributions to the extent such shares, on an as converted basis, represent in excess of 9.9% of our common stock and voting power as of the date of the Distributions. The Affiliated Holders may, at any time, request that we seek Education Regulatory Approval or make a good faith determination that such approval is not required. If we are required to or elect to obtain Education Regulatory Approval and if such approvals are not obtained within the 120-day time period set forth in the Certificate of Designations, the dividend rates with respect to the Cash Dividend and Accrued Dividend (each as defined in the Certificate of Designations) will be increased by 5.0% per year, not to exceed a maximum of 14.5% per year, subject to downward adjustment on obtaining the foregoing approvals
32



As of September 30, 2020, as a result of the removal of the Conversion Cap and the Investor Voting Cap, the Unaffiliated Holders and the Affiliated Holders were entitled to vote their Series A Preferred Stock in an amount equal to 12,968,878 shares of common stock on a fully diluted basis. Those holders may also convert such shares of Series A Preferred Stock and receive approximately 30.03 shares of common stock for each share of Series A Preferred Stock converted, resulting in our issuance of up to 12,968,878 shares of common stock if such shares of Series A Preferred Stock were all converted. On a fully converted basis, the shares of Series A Preferred Stock are convertible into 21,021,021 shares of common stock. Holders of shares of Series A Preferred Stock are entitled to vote with the holders of shares of common stock and any other class or series similarly entitled to vote with the holders of common stock and not as a separate class, at any annual or special meeting of stockholders, and may act by written consent in the same manner as the holders of common stock, on an as converted basis. Shares of Series A Preferred Stock are convertible to common stock at any time at the option of the holder, subject to the Continuing Caps.

Any conversion of Series A Preferred Stock into common stock would dilute the ownership interest of existing holders of our common stock, and any sales in the public market of the common stock issuable upon such conversion could adversely affect prevailing market prices of our common stock. We have granted Coliseum Holdings and certain recipients of Series A Preferred Stock in the Distributions registration rights in respect of the shares of Series A Preferred Stock and any shares of common stock issued upon conversion thereof. These registration rights could facilitate the resale of such securities into the public market, and any resale of these securities would increase the number of shares of our common stock available for public trading. Sales of a substantial number of shares of our common stock in the public market, or the perception that such sales might occur, could have a material adverse effect on the price of our common stock.

Additionally, a majority of the voting power of the Series A Preferred Stock must approve certain significant corporate actions, such as (i) amendments to our Certificate of Incorporation or bylaws in a manner adverse to the rights, preferences, privileges or voting powers of the holders of Series A Preferred Stock, (ii) the creation or issuance of a series of stock, or other security convertible into a series of stock, with equal or greater rights than those of the holders of Series A Preferred Stock, (iii) the issuance of equity securities, or securities convertible into equity securities, at a price that is 25% below fair market value at the time of issuance, (iv) subject to certain exceptions, the incurrence of indebtedness, (v) subject to certain exceptions, the sale or licensing of any of our material assets, (vi) subject to certain exceptions, the consummation of acquisitions (of stock or assets), (vii) subject to certain exceptions, the payment of certain dividends or distributions with respect to a series of stock junior to the Series A Preferred Stock, (viii) the voluntary liquidation, dissolution or winding-up of UTI if the Series A Preferred Stock would not have the option to receive the liquidation preference then in effect upon such liquidation, dissolution or winding-up, or (ix) subject to certain exceptions, any merger, consolidation, recapitalization, reclassification or other transaction in which substantially all of our common stock is exchanged or converted into cash, securities or property and in which the holders of the Series A Preferred Stock shall not have the option to receive the full liquidation preference as a result of that transaction.

The interests of the holders of the Series A Preferred Stock may not always coincide with the interests of our other stockholders and Coliseum Holdings’ concentration of ownership may have the effect of delaying or preventing a change of control of UTI otherwise favored by our other stockholders and could depress our stock price.

The price of our common stock has fluctuated significantly in the past and may continue to do so in the future. As a result, you could lose all or part of your investment.

Volatility in the market price of our common stock may prevent you from being able to sell your shares at or above the price you paid for your shares. The market price of our common stock has fluctuated significantly in the past, and may continue to fluctuate significantly for a variety of different reasons, including, without limitation:

developments regarding the accreditation or state licensing;
our quarterly or annual earnings or those of other companies in our industry;
public reaction to our press releases, corporate communications and SEC filings;
changes in earnings estimates or recommendations by research analysts who track our common stock or the stocks of other companies in our industry;
seasonal variations in our student enrollment;
new laws or regulations or new interpretations of laws or regulations applicable to our industry or business;
33


negative publicity, including government hearings and other public lawmaker or regulator criticism, regarding our industry or business;
changes in enrollment;
changes in accounting standards, policies, guidance, interpretations or principles;
litigation involving our company or investigations or audits by regulators into the operations of our company or our competitors;
sales of common stock by our directors, executive officers and significant stockholders; and
changes in general conditions in the United States and global economies or financial markets, including those resulting from health epidemics, war, incidents of terrorism or responses to such events.

In addition, in recent years, the stock market has experienced extreme price and volume fluctuations. This volatility has had a significant impact on the market price of securities issued by many companies, including companies in our industry. Changes may occur without regard to the operating performance of these companies. The price of our common stock could fluctuate based upon factors that have little or nothing to do with our company.

Seasonal and other fluctuations in our results of operations could adversely affect the trading price of our common stock.

In reviewing our results of operations, you should not focus on quarter-to-quarter comparisons. Our results in any quarter may not indicate the results we may achieve in any subsequent quarter or for the full year. Our revenues normally fluctuate as a result of seasonal variations in our business, principally due to changes in total student population. Student population varies as a result of new student enrollments, graduations and student attrition. Historically, our schools have had lower student populations in our third fiscal quarter than in the remainder of our fiscal year because fewer students are enrolled during the summer months. Our expenses, however, do not generally vary at the same rate as changes in our student population and revenues and, as a result, such expenses do not fluctuate significantly on a quarterly basis. We expect quarterly fluctuations in results of operations to continue as a result of seasonal enrollment patterns. Such patterns may change, however, as a result of acquisitions, new school openings, new program introductions and increased enrollments of adult students. Additionally, our revenues for our first fiscal quarter are adversely affected by the fact that we do not recognize revenue during the calendar year-end holiday break, which falls primarily in that quarter. These fluctuations may result in volatility or have an adverse effect on the market price of our common stock.
ITEM 1B. UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS
None.

ITEM 2. PROPERTIES

Campuses and Other Properties

The following sets forth certain information relating to our campuses and corporate headquarters. Many of the leases are renewable for additional terms at our option.
Location Brand Approximate Square Footage Leased or Owned Lease Expiration Date
Campus locations:
Arizona (Avondale) UTI 283,000  Leased June 2024
Arizona (Phoenix) MMI 117,000  Leased December 2022
New Jersey (Bloomfield) UTI 102,000 Leased December 2030
California (Long Beach) UTI 137,000 Leased August 2030
California (Rancho Cucamonga) UTI 148,000  Leased September 2031
California (Sacramento)(1)
UTI 245,000  Leased February 2033
Florida (Orlando) UTI/MMI 263,000  Leased August 2022
Illinois (Lisle) UTI 187,000  Leased December 2032
North Carolina (Mooresville) NASCAR Tech 146,000  Leased September 2022
34


Location Brand Approximate Square Footage Leased or Owned Lease Expiration Date
Pennsylvania (Exton) UTI 129,000  Leased October 2029
Texas (Dallas/Ft. Worth) UTI 95,000  Owned N/A
Texas (Houston) UTI 172,000  Owned N/A
Other locations:
Arizona (Phoenix) Corporate Headquarters 29,000  Leased December 2025
Arizona (Phoenix) Operational Support 47,000 Leased December 2022

(1) In September 2020, we signed an amendment to the lease for our Sacramento campus which extended that lease through February 2033. Additionally, this amendment will reduce our leased space by approximately 128,000 square feet to 117,000 square feet effective as of January 1, 2022.
ITEM 3. LEGAL PROCEEDINGS
In the ordinary conduct of our business, we are periodically subject to lawsuits, demands in arbitrations, investigations, regulatory proceedings or other claims, including, but not limited to, claims involving current and former students, routine employment matters, business disputes and regulatory demands.  When we are aware of a claim or potential claim, we assess the likelihood of any loss or exposure. If it is probable that a loss will result and the amount of the loss can be reasonably estimated, we would accrue a liability for the loss. When a loss is not both probable and estimable, we do not accrue a liability. Where a loss is not probable but is reasonably possible, including if a loss in excess of an accrued liability is reasonably possible, we determine whether it is possible to provide an estimate of the amount of the loss or range of possible losses for the claim. Because we cannot predict with certainty the ultimate resolution of the legal proceedings (including lawsuits, investigations, regulatory proceedings or claims) asserted against us, it is not currently possible to provide such an estimate. The ultimate outcome of pending legal proceedings to which we are a party may have a material adverse effect on our business, cash flows, results of operations or financial condition.

ITEM 4. MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURES
None.
35


PART II

ITEM 5. MARKET FOR REGISTRANT’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES

Market Information

Our common stock is listed on the NYSE under the symbol “UTI.”

The closing price of our common stock as reported by the NYSE on November 30, 2020 was $6.56 per share. As of November 30, 2020, there were 25 holders of record of our common stock.

Dividends

On June 9, 2016, our board of directors voted to eliminate the quarterly cash dividend on our common stock. Any future common stock dividends require the approval of a majority of the voting power of the Series A Preferred Stock.

We continuously evaluate our cash position in light of growth opportunities, operating results and general market conditions.

Repurchase of Securities

On December 20, 2011, our board of directors authorized the repurchase of up to $25.0 million of our common stock in the open market or through privately negotiated transactions. As of September 30, 2020, we have purchased an aggregate of 1,677,570 shares of our common stock for an aggregate purchase price of $15.3 million under this stock repurchase program. During the year ended September 30, 2020, we made no purchases under this stock repurchase program. The last stock repurchase under this stock repurchase program was during fiscal 2015. Any future repurchases under this stock repurchase program require the approval of a majority of the voting power of our Series A Preferred Stock.



36


Stock Performance Graph

The following Stock Performance Graph and related information shall not be deemed “soliciting material” or “filed” with the SEC, nor should such information be incorporated by reference into any future filings under the Securities Act or the Exchange Act except to the extent that we specifically incorporate it by reference in such filing.

This graph compares total cumulative stockholder return on our common stock during the period from September 30, 2015 through September 30, 2020 with the cumulative return on the NYSE Stock Market Index (U.S. Companies) and a Peer Issuer Group Index. The peer issuer group consists of the companies identified below, which were selected on the basis of the similar nature of their business. The graph assumes that $100 was invested on September 30, 2015, and any dividends were reinvested on the date on which they were paid.

UTI-20200930_G1.JPG

Symbol CRSP Total Returns Index for: 09/2015 09/2016 09/2017 09/2018 09/2019 09/2020
u Universal Technical Institute, Inc. $ 100.00  $ 51.18  $ 99.76  $ 76.48  $ 156.40  $ 146.05 
n NYSE Stock Market (US Companies) 100.00  114.41  133.27  150.92  156.20  156.86 
p Peer Group 100.00  99.90  185.53  244.09  216.13  163.86 
Companies in the Self-Determined Peer Group:
Adtalem Global Education, Inc. Career Education Corporation
Grand Canyon Education, Inc. Lincoln Educational Services Corporation
Strategic Education, Inc. Zovio, Inc.
Notes:
A. The lines represent quarterly index levels derived from compounded daily returns that include all dividends.
B. Peer group indices use beginning of period market capitalization weighting.
C. If the quarterly interval, based on the fiscal year-end, is not a trading day, the preceding trading day is used.
D. The index level for all series was set to $100 on September 30, 2015.
Prepared by Zacks Investment Research, Inc. Used with permission. All rights reserved.
37


ITEM 6. SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA

The following table sets forth our selected consolidated financial and operating data as of and for the periods indicated. You should read the selected financial data set forth below together with “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and our consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this Annual Report on Form 10-K. The selected consolidated statement of operations data and the selected consolidated balance sheet data as of and for the years ended September 30, 2020, 2019, 2018, 2017 and 2016 have been derived from our consolidated financial statements.
Year Ended September 30,
2020(1)
2019(2)
2018(3)
2017
2016(4)
Statement of Operations Data: (In thousands, except per share amounts, number of campuses and average enrollments)
Revenues $ 300,761  $ 331,504  $ 316,965  $ 324,263  $ 347,146 
Operating expenses:
Educational services and facilities 155,932  178,317  182,589  181,027  194,395 
Selling, general and administrative 148,700  160,989  169,651  145,060  171,374 
Total operating expenses 304,632  339,306  352,240  326,087  365,769 
Loss from operations (3,871) (7,802) (35,275) (1,824) (18,623)
Net income (loss) $ 8,008  $ (7,868) $ (32,682) $ (8,128) $ (47,696)
Earnings per share:
Net income (loss) per share - basic $ 0.05  $ (0.52) $ (1.51) $ (0.54) $ (2.02)
Net income (loss) per share - diluted $ 0.05  $ (0.52) $ (1.51) $ (0.54) $ (2.02)
Weighted average number of shares outstanding:
Basic 29,812  25,438  25,115  24,712  24,313 
Diluted 30,113  25,438  25,115  24,712  24,313 
Cash dividends declared per common share(5)
$ —  $ —  $ —  $ —  $ 0.04 
Other Data:
Depreciation and amortization(6)
$ 11,804  $ 15,904  $ 15,688  $ 16,886  $ 17,749 
Number of campuses
12  13  13  12  12 
Average enrollments 10,462  10,674  10,418  10,889  12,026 
Balance Sheet Data:
Cash, cash equivalents and short-term investments $ 114,858  $ 65,442  $ 58,104  $ 97,917  $ 120,736 
Current assets 180,179  118,104  116,795  146,826  161,949 
Working capital 58,539  21,260  24,333  60,437  67,389 
Total assets 441,981  270,526  282,278  274,102  297,159 
Total shareholders’ equity
176,522  114,288  126,645  125,776  136,614 

(1) Our results of operations for the year ended September 30, 2020 were impacted by the COVID-19 pandemic. More students took a leave of absence in fiscal 2020 due to the COVID-19 pandemic and our campuses suspended operations for a period of time. While we have transitioned to a blended learning model, the COVID-19 pandemic has impacted the pace in which students are progressing through their programs. As a result, our total graduates in fiscal 2020 decreased by 19% as compared to the prior year due to these delays. We recorded $6.1 million in deferred revenue during the year ended September 30, 2020.

38


In February 2020, we raised $49.5 million of net proceeds through an equity offering which was focused on supporting our longer-term strategy of growth, diversification and scale. We invested a portion of the proceeds from the equity offering in held-to-maturity securities.

Additionally, we adopted ASC 842, Leases, at the beginning of fiscal 2020 using the modified retrospective method without the recasting of comparative periods’ financial information which resulted in recording an operating lease liability of $163.0 million and an operating lease right-of-use asset of $148.6 million on October 1, 2019.

(2) In February 2019, we announced that the Norwood, Massachusetts campus is no longer accepting new student applications. The last group of students started in March 2019, and the campus closed on July 31, 2020. We recorded a $1.4 million restructuring charge for the Norwood campus exit during fiscal 2019, which impacted operating expenses and the loss from operations.

(3) In fiscal 2018, we opened a campus in Bloomfield, New Jersey. The implementation spanned most of fiscal 2018 and we commenced teaching at this campus in August 2018, which contributed to the fluctuations in operations and financial position during fiscal 2018. Additionally, we adopted ASC 606, Revenue from Contracts from Customers, at the beginning of fiscal 2018 using the modified retrospective method. The adoption of this standard resulted in the change in the timing of revenue recognition as it relates to our proprietary loan program.

(4) In fiscal 2016, we sold 700,000 shares of Series A Preferred Stock for $70.0 million in cash. Additionally, during fiscal 2016 we recorded a full valuation allowance on our deferred tax assets which impacted income tax expense by $34.2 million for the year ended September 30, 2016.

(5) In fiscal 2016, we paid common stock cash dividends of $0.02 per share in December and March totaling $1.0 million. On June 9, 2016, our board of directors voted to eliminate the quarterly cash dividend on our common stock.

(6) Excludes depreciation of training equipment obtained in exchange for services of $1.3 million, $1.4 million, $1.4 million, $1.3 million and $1.3 million for the years ended September 30, 2020, 2019, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.


39


ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

You should read the following discussion together with the "Selected Financial Data" and the consolidated financial statements and the related notes included elsewhere in this Annual Report on Form 10-K. This discussion contains forward-looking statements that are based on our current expectations, estimates and projections about our business and operations. Our actual results may differ materially from those currently anticipated and expressed in such forward-looking statements as a result of a number of factors, including those we discuss under “Risk Factors” “Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements” and elsewhere in this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

General Overview

We are the leading provider of postsecondary education for students seeking careers as professional automotive, diesel, collision repair, motorcycle and marine technicians as measured by total average full-time enrollment and graduates. We also provide programs for welders and CNC machining technicians. We offer certificate, diploma or degree programs at 12 campuses across the United States, excluding the Norwood, Massachusetts campus which was closed on July 31, 2020. Additionally, we offer MSAT programs, including student-paid electives, at our campuses and manufacturer or dealer sponsored training at certain campuses and dedicated training centers. Founded in 1965, we have provided technical education for more than 55 years and have graduated more than 220,000 technicians.

Our revenues consist primarily of student tuition and fees derived from the programs we provide after reductions are made for discounts and scholarships that we sponsor and for refunds for students who withdraw from our programs prior to specified dates. Tuition and fee revenue is recognized ratably over the term of the course or program offered. Approximately 99%, 99% and 98% of our revenues for each of the years ended September 30, 2020, 2019 and 2018, respectively, consisted of gross tuition. We supplement our tuition and fee revenues with additional revenues from sales of textbooks and program supplies and other revenues, which are recognized as the transfer of goods or services occurs. Through our proprietary loan program, we, in substance, provide the students who participate in this program with extended payment terms for a portion of their tuition. Under ASC 606, the portion of tuition revenue related to the proprietary loan program is considered a form of variable consideration. We estimate the amount we ultimately expect to collect from the portion of tuition that is funded by the proprietary loan program, resulting in a note receivable. Estimating the collection rate requires significant management judgment. The estimated amount is determined at the inception of the contract and we recognize the related revenue as the student progresses through school. Each reporting period, we update our assessment of the variable consideration associated with the proprietary loan program. Accordingly, we recognize tuition and loan origination fees financed by the loan and any related interest revenue under the effective interest method required under the loan based on this collection rate. Tuition revenue and fees generally vary based on the average number of students enrolled and average tuition charged per program. We also provide dealer technician training or instructor staffing services to manufacturers, and we recognize revenue as the transfer of services occurs.

Average full-time enrollments vary depending on, among other factors, the number of continuing students at the beginning of a period, new student enrollments during the period, students who have previously withdrawn but decide to re-enroll during the period, graduations and withdrawals during the period. Our average full-time enrollments are influenced by the:

Attractiveness of our program offerings to high school graduates and potential adult students;
Effectiveness of our marketing efforts;
Depth of our industry relationships;
Strength of employment markets and long-term career prospects;
Quality of our instructors and student services professionals;
Persistence of our students; the length of our education programs;
Availability of federal and alternative funding for our programs; and
Number of graduates of our programs who elect to attend the advanced training programs we offer and general economic conditions.

Our introduction of additional program offerings at existing campuses and opening additional campuses is expected to influence our average full-time enrollment. We currently offer start dates at our campuses that range from every three to six weeks throughout the year in our core programs. The number of start dates of advanced training programs varies by the
40


duration of those programs and the needs of the manufacturers which sponsor them.

Our tuition charges vary by type and length of our programs and the program level, such as core or advanced training. We implemented tuition rate increases of up to 3.5%, 3.0% and 2.5% for each of the years ended September 30, 2020, 2019 and 2018, respectively. We regularly evaluate our tuition pricing based on individual campus markets, the competitive environment and ED regulations.

Most students at our campuses rely on funds received under various government-sponsored student financial aid programs, predominantly Title IV Programs and various veterans' benefits programs, to pay a substantial portion of their tuition and other education-related expenses. Approximately 66% of our revenues, on a cash basis, were collected from funds distributed under Title IV Programs for the year ended September 30, 2020 as calculated under the 90/10 rule. Additionally, approximately 17% of our revenues, on a cash basis, were collected from funds distributed under various veterans' benefits programs for the year ended September 30, 2020.

We extend credit for tuition and fees, for a limited period of time, to the majority of our students. Our credit risk is mitigated through the students’ participation in federally funded financial aid and veterans' benefit programs unless students withdraw prior to the receipt by us of Title IV or veterans' benefit funds for those students. The financial aid and veterans' benefits programs are subject to political and budgetary considerations. There is no assurance that such funding will be maintained at current levels. Extensive and complex regulations govern the financial assistance programs in which our students participate. Our administration of these programs is periodically reviewed by various regulatory agencies. Any regulatory violation could be the basis for the initiation of potential adverse actions, including a suspension, limitation, placement on reimbursement status or termination proceeding, which could have a material adverse effect on our business.

If any of our institutions were to lose its eligibility to participate in federal student financial aid or veterans' benefit programs, the students at that institution, and other locations of that institution, would lose access to funds derived from those programs and would have to seek alternative sources of funds to pay their tuition and fees. The receipt of financial aid and veterans benefit funds reduces the students’ amounts due to us and has no impact on revenue recognition, as the transfer relates to the source of funding for the costs of education which may occur through Title IV, veterans benefit or other funds and resources available to the student. Additionally, we bear all credit and collection risk for the portion of our student tuition that is funded through our proprietary loan program.

We categorize our operating expenses as (i) educational services and facilities and (ii) selling, general and administrative.

Major components of educational services and facilities expenses include faculty and other campus administration employees compensation and benefits, facility rent, maintenance, utilities, depreciation and amortization of property and equipment used in the provision of educational services, tools, training aids, royalties under our licensing arrangements and other costs directly associated with teaching our programs and providing educational services to our students.

Selling, general and administrative expenses include compensation and benefits of employees who are not directly associated with the provision of educational services, such as: executive management; finance and central accounting; information technology; legal; human resources; marketing and student enrollment expenses, including compensation and benefits of personnel employed in marketing and student admissions; costs of professional services; bad debt expense; costs associated with the implementation and operation of our student management and reporting system; rent for our corporate office headquarters; depreciation and amortization of property and equipment that is not used in the provision of educational services, and other costs that are incidental to our operations. All marketing and student enrollment expenses are recognized in the period incurred. Costs related to the opening of new facilities, excluding related capital expenditures, are expensed in the period incurred or when services are provided.

2020 Overview

Impact of COVID-19

On March 19, 2020, we suspended all in-person classes at all of our campuses for the safety and protection of our students and staff, to help slow the spread of COVID-19 and to comply with state and local orders and restrictions. Upon the suspension of all in-person classes, we provided all students with the opportunity to take a leave of absence or to continue their education via an online curriculum. On March 25, 2020, we began offering the classroom portion of our training online so that the more than 8,000 students who elected to remain active in the program could continue their education remotely. As
41


our training is a combination of classroom lectures and hands-on labs, there is a portion of most classes that cannot be delivered online and needs to be completed in-person at the campus labs.

We transitioned our on-campus, in-person education model to a blended training model that combines instructor-facilitated online teaching and demonstrations with hands-on labs. On-campus labs have been redesigned to meet the health, safety and social distancing guidelines imposed by the CDC and state and local jurisdictions, while still meeting our accreditation and curriculum requirements. Both the ED and the ACCSC granted institutions temporary approval to offer distance learning through December 31, 2020. To afford us additional flexibility beyond the current temporary approval period(s), we have initiated the approval process with the ACCSC and the appropriate state agencies to be able to offer distance education and a blended learning format for all of our programs on a more permanent basis. In May 2020, we resumed in-person labs at eight of our campus locations. Four of our campuses resumed in-person labs in June 2020, and our final campus in Bloomfield, New Jersey resumed in-person labs on July 1, 2020. As previously planned, we completed the teach-out of our Norwood, Massachusetts campus and it closed on July 31, 2020.

Once a student returns to campus for in-person labs, under the new guidelines it takes on average approximately six to nine weeks for that student to catch-up on the lab work that he was unable to complete during the campus closure and prior to his return. Additionally, as of September 30, 2020, approximately 5% of students had not returned to campus to complete the in-person labs and remain only in the online portion of the curriculum, essentially only completing half of each course, while approximately 28% of students were completing catch up labs, but over an extended period of time. We continue to recognize revenue ratably over the term of the course or program offered, taking into consideration those only completing the online curriculum, and the catch up period for active students and the impact it has on expected graduation dates. As a result, as of September 30, 2020, we had deferred revenue of $6.1 million.

While we have reopened all of our campus locations, some students have delayed returning to campus for in-person labs even with the new social distancing protocols in place and remain on leave of absence or continue only with the online instruction portion of the curriculum. If students continue to remain on a leave of absence, withdraw, or do not make up the required in person labs on a timely basis, our revenues could continue to be impacted in fiscal 2021.

Student Metrics

End of period undergraduate full-time student enrollment as of September 30, 2020 and 2019 was 12,524 and 12,363, respectively, representing growth of 1.3% despite the impacts of the COVID-19 pandemic.

We experienced a 2.0% decline in our average full-time enrollment to 10,462 students for the year ended September 30, 2020 as compared to the prior year period. Excluding the Norwood, Massachusetts campus, we started 11,283 students during the year ended September 30, 2020, which represents a decrease of 2.4% from the same period during fiscal 2019. The decrease in full-time enrollment and starts was primarily the result of the COVID-19 pandemic.

Our ability to start new students continues to be influenced by various factors including: unemployment rates; competition; adverse media coverage, legislative hearings, regulatory actions and investigations by attorneys general and various agencies related to allegations of wrongdoing on the part of other companies within the education and training services industry, which have cast the industry in a negative light; and the state of the general macro-economic environment and its impact on price sensitivity and the ability and willingness of students and their families to incur debt. For more information, see Item 1A. “Risk Factors.”

Operations

Our revenues for the year ended September 30, 2020 were $300.8 million, a decrease of $30.7 million, or 9.3%, from the prior year. The decrease in revenue was primarily due to the COVID-19 pandemic as more students were on leave of absence during the year and our campuses suspended operations for a period of time. While we have transitioned to a blended learning model, the COVID-19 pandemic has impacted the pace in which students are progressing through their programs. As a result, our total graduates in fiscal 2020 decreased by 19% as compared to the prior year. Additionally, our revenue was impacted by our exit of the Norwood, Massachusetts campus in July 2020. We had $1.4 million of revenue from Norwood in fiscal 2020, compared to $8.5 million in the prior year. Revenues were favorably impacted in fiscal 2020 from the opening of our Bloomfield, New Jersey campus in fiscal 2018. We had $14.6 million in revenue from Bloomfield in fiscal 2020, as compared to $10.9 million in fiscal 2019 when the campus was still ramping up.

42


In fiscal 2020, we had an operating loss of $3.9 million, as compared to an operating loss of $7.8 million for the same period in the prior year. Our operating expenses for fiscal 2020 decreased 10.2% as compared to the prior year primarily due to cost management initiatives, as well as decreases in compensation and benefit costs, depreciation expense, and contract and professional services expenses. Productivity improvements and proactive cost actions have been a key part of our operating model for the past several years, and we continue to identify and execute on efficiency opportunities throughout our cost structure, while improving and investing in the overall student experience. Net income for the year ended September 30, 2020 was $8.0 million, compared to a net loss of $7.9 million in the prior year, and includes a $10.7 million tax benefit resulting from the application of revised net operating loss carryback regulations from the CARES Act.

During fiscal 2020, we were granted approximately $33.0 million in HEERF funds under the CARES Act, with $16.5 million exclusively for emergency financial aid grants to students impacted by COVID-19 and $16.5 million to cover institutional costs associated with significant changes to the delivery of instruction due to coronavirus. As of September 30, 2020, we have awarded all $16.5 million designated for student grants. During the year ended September 30, 2020, we drew down $13.9 million of the institutional funds into our operating cash account as partial reimbursement for the $15.7 million of eligible costs incurred during fiscal 2020.

We continue to focus on the following key strategies as we identify opportunities for growth:

Expanding into new geographic markets either organically or through strategic acquisitions;
Offering new programs, such as expanding our welding program to additional campus locations, and offering associate level degree programs at additional campus locations;
Maintaining and expanding our manufacturer brand partners and other employers to provide career opportunities and tuition reimbursement for our graduates;
Identifying and executing on a variety of affordability initiatives for our students, including employer financial support and institutional scholarships and grants; and
Shifting perceptions and building advocacy with key policy makers and influencers.

Results of Operations
The following table sets forth selected statements of operations data as a percentage of revenues for each of the periods indicated.
  Year Ended September 30,
  2020 2019 2018
Revenues 100.0  % 100.0  % 100.0  %
Operating expenses:
Educational services and facilities 51.9  % 53.8  % 57.6  %
Selling, general and administrative 49.4  % 48.6  % 53.5  %
Total operating expenses 101.3  % 102.4  % 111.1  %
Loss from operations (1.3) % (2.4) % (11.1) %
Interest income (expense), net 0.4  % (0.5) % (0.6) %
Other income —  % 0.6  % 0.4  %
Total other income (expense), net 0.4  % 0.1  % (0.2) %
Loss before income taxes (0.9) % (2.3) % (11.3) %
Income tax benefit (expense) 3.5  % (0.1) % 1.0  %
Net income (loss) 2.6  % (2.4) % (10.3) %
Preferred stock dividends 1.8  % 1.6  % 1.7  %
Income (loss) available for distribution 0.8  % (4.0) % (12.0) %
43



Year Ended September 30, 2020 Compared to Year Ended September 30, 2019
Revenues
Our revenues for the year ended September 30, 2020 were $300.8 million, a decrease of $30.7 million, or 9.3%, as compared to revenues of $331.5 million for the year ended September 30, 2019. Our average full-time student enrollment decreased by 2.0% primarily due to a higher number of students who went on a leave of absence during the three months ended June 30, 2020 due to the COVID-19 pandemic. Additionally, timing of revenue recognition for active students has been impacted by additional time needed to complete in-person catch-up labs that were unable to be completed during the time the campuses were closed and by students retaking courses that were previously completed. As a result of the catch up labs not yet completed, as of September 30, 2020, we have deferred revenue of $6.1 million.
We recognized $5.1 million on an accrual basis related to revenues and interest under our proprietary loan program for the year ended September 30, 2020, as compared to $6.8 million recognized for the year ended September 30, 2019. The decrease in overall fiscal year 2020 revenues was also partially attributable to a $1.5 million decrease in revenues from student-paid MSATs for the year ended September 30, 2020 as compared to the prior year period.
Educational services and facilities expenses
Our educational services and facilities expenses for the year ended September 30, 2020 were $155.9 million, representing a decrease of $22.4 million, or 12.6%, as compared to $178.3 million for the year ended September 30, 2019.

The following table sets forth the significant components of our educational services and facilities expenses (in thousands):
Year Ended September 30,
2020 2019
Salaries expense $ 71,516  $ 78,195 
Employee benefits and tax 11,911  15,972 
Bonus expense 1,023  550 
Stock-based compensation 64  — 
Compensation and related costs 84,514  94,717 
Depreciation and amortization expense 12,187  15,811 
Occupancy costs 37,742  35,783 
Other educational services and facilities expenses (2,099) 11,560 
Supplies and maintenance expense 15,282  10,840 
Contract services expense 2,801  3,501 
Taxes and licensing expense 2,319  3,479 
Student expense $ 3,186  $ 2,626 
Total educational services and facilities expense 155,932  178,317 

Compensation and related costs decreased $10.2 million for the year ended September 30, 2020, as compared to the prior year:

Salaries expense decreased $6.7 million primarily due to an approximate 6% decrease in full-time employee headcount. The decrease in headcount was primarily due to attrition and productivity improvements. Furloughs enacted to offset revenue decreases from the COVID-19 pandemic also reduced salaries expense.
Employee benefits and tax decreased $4.1 million also primarily due to lower headcount and lower cost per employee from implementing new benefit plans at the beginning of fiscal 2020.

Depreciation and amortization expense decreased $3.6 million during the year ended September 30, 2020 primarily due to the adoption of ASC 842 as of October 1, 2019, whereby the assets that were previously financed by finance obligations were converted to operating leases. Subsequent to the adoption of ASC 842, the assets relating to the operating leases were
44


classified as “Right-of-use assets for operating leases” on the consolidated balance sheet and the related operating lease expense was rolled into “Occupancy costs” in the table above.

Occupancy costs increased $2.0 million during the year ended September 30, 2020. The increase was primarily attributed to the adoption of ASC 842 as of October 1, 2019 as described above partially offset by cost reductions from closing our Norwood, Massachusetts campus, relocating and downsizing our headquarters facility, and downsizing our Exton, Pennsylvania campus.

Other educational services and facilities expense decreased by $13.7 million, which includes a $13.3 million credit for the year ended September 30, 2020 from the institutional HEERF funds for the reimbursement of allowable costs related to the changes in the delivery of instruction due to the coronavirus. The allowable costs were included in the relevant line items above. See Note 21 in the notes to our Consolidated Financial Statements within Part II, Item 8 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K for further information on the HEERF funds.

Supplies and maintenance expense increased by $4.4 million primarily due to $5.7 million in laptops purchased for our students to support their transition to the new blended on-line learning model. The laptops were one of the allowable costs qualifying for reimbursement from the institutional HEERF funds received.

Contract services expense decreased $0.7 million during the year ended September 30, 2020 primarily due to phasing out contracts with third parties and absorbing these responsibilities internally.

Taxes and licensing expenses decreased by $1.2 million, primarily due to a $0.7 million decrease in taxes and licensing fees for properties in use and a $0.4 million decrease in sales and use taxes.

Selling, general and administrative expenses

Our selling, general and administrative expenses for the year ended September 30, 2020 were $148.7 million, representing a decrease of $12.3 million, or 7.6%, as compared to $161.0 million for the year ended September 30, 2019.

The following table sets forth the significant components of our selling, general and administrative expenses (in thousands):
  Year Ended September 30,
2020 2019
Salaries expense $ 57,266  $ 57,827 
Employee benefits and tax 11,539  14,130 
Bonus expense 11,116  10,718 
Stock-based compensation 2,013  1,440 
Compensation and related costs 81,934  84,115 
Advertising expense 39,707  41,163 
Other selling, general and administrative expenses 17,961  21,140 
Contract services expense 4,307  8,401 
Professional services expense 3,828  4,690 
Depreciation and amortization expense 963  1,480 
Total selling, general and administrative expenses $ 148,700  $ 160,989 

Compensation and related costs decreased by $2.2 million for the year ended September 30, 2020, as compared to the prior year:

Salaries expense decreased by $0.6 million, primarily due to lower headcount compared to the prior year, partially offset by costs related to the retirement of Kimberly J. McWaters, our former President and Chief Executive Officer, in October 2019.
Employee benefits and tax decreased by $2.6 million, primarily due to lower headcount and lower cost per employee from implementing new benefit plans at the beginning of fiscal 2020.
45


Stock-based compensation expense increased by $0.6 million, due to new awards granted during fiscal 2020. There were no stock-based compensation awards granted during fiscal 2019.
Advertising expense decreased by $1.5 million for the year ended September 30, 2020, as compared to the prior year. The decrease was attributable to targeted cost-efficient marketing efforts, with a shift away from television advertising toward digital media. Advertising expense as a percentage of revenues remained relatively consistent at approximately 13.2% for the year ended September 30, 2020 as compared to 12.4% in the prior year.
Other selling, general and administrative decreased by $3.2 million. Other selling, general and administrative expenses includes a $1.8 million credit for year ended September 30, 2020 from the institutional HEERF funds for the reimbursement of allowable costs related to the changes in the delivery of instruction due to the coronavirus. The allowable costs were included in the relevant line items above. See Note 21 of the notes to our Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements within Part II, Item 8 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K for further information on the HEERF funds. Also contributing to the favorable cost trend were decreases in travel and entertainment of $1.5 million.
Contract services expense decreased $4.1 million for the year ended September 30, 2020. The decrease was attributable to a one-time, non-recurring $4.0 million consultant termination fee recognized during the year ended September 30, 2019.
Professional services expense decreased by $0.9 million primarily attributable to a decreases in legal fees of $0.5 million and broad decreases related to external professional services due to cost control measures.

Other income (expense)

Other income for the year ended September 30, 2020 was $1.3 million, an increase of $1.1 million as compared to other expense of $0.1 million for the year ended September 30, 2019. The $1.3 million of other income in fiscal 2020 was comprised primarily of interest income from our held-to-maturity investments. The adoption of ASC 842 as of October 1, 2019 resulted in the de-recognition of the assets associated with our financing obligations, which were previously included in property and equipment during the year ended September 30, 2019 and contributed $3.2 million of interest expense during that period. This was partially offset by tenant rent income in the prior period of $1.5 million which was not present during the year ended September 30, 2020 also due to the impacts of the ASC 842 adoption.
Income taxes
Our income tax benefit for the year ended September 30, 2020 was $10.6 million, or (408.7%) of pre-tax loss, compared to income tax expense of $0.2 million, or 2.6% of pre-tax loss, for the year ended September 30, 2019. The effective income tax rate in each period differed from the federal statutory tax rate of 21% primarily as a result of changes in the valuation allowance and state taxes. Our income tax benefit or expense was impacted by a decrease of $6.1 million and an increase of $1.5 million in the valuation allowance during the years ended September 30, 2020 and 2019, respectively. The significant decrease in the valuation allowance for the year ended September 30, 2020, and the related income tax benefit, was primarily attributable to the carryback of NOLs under the provisions of the CARES Act and the adoption of ASC 842 as of October 1, 2019. The income tax expense for the year September 30, 2019 was related to certain state taxes. We will maintain a valuation allowance on our deferred tax assets until sufficient positive evidence exists to support its reversal. See Note 13 of the notes to our Consolidated Financial Statements within Part II, Item 8 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K for further discussion.

Preferred stock dividends

On June 24, 2016, we sold 700,000 shares of Series A Preferred Stock for $70.0 million in cash, less $1.2 million in issuance costs. Pursuant to this sale, we paid preferred stock cash dividends totaling $5.3 million during the years ended September 30, 2020 and 2019, respectively. See Note 15 of the notes to our Consolidated Financial Statements within Part II, Item 8 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K for further discussion of the preferred stock transaction.

Income (loss) available for distribution

Income (loss) available for distribution refers to net income (loss) reduced by dividends on our Series A Preferred Stock. As a result of the foregoing, we reported income available for distribution for the year ended September 30, 2020 of $2.7 million, as compared to a loss available for distribution of $13.1 million for the year ended September 30, 2019.    
46



For a discussion of the financial results of operations for the year ended September 30, 2019 compared to the year ended September 30 2018, refer to Part I, Item 7 of our 2019 Form 10-K filed with the SEC on December 6, 2019 which discussion is incorporated herein by reference and which is available free of charge on the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov.

Non-GAAP Financial Measures

Our earnings before interest, tax, depreciation and amortization (“EBITDA”) for the years ended September 30, 2020, 2019 and 2018 were $9.4 million, $11.4 million and $(16.7) million, respectively. We define EBITDA as net income (loss) for the year, before interest (income) expense, income tax (benefit) expense, and depreciation and amortization.
    
EBITDA is a non-GAAP financial measure which is provided to supplement, but not substitute for, the most directly comparable GAAP measure. We choose to disclose this non-GAAP financial measure because it provides an additional analytical tool to clarify our results from operations and helps to identify underlying trends. Additionally, this measure helps compare our performance on a consistent basis across time periods. Management also utilizes EBITDA as an internal performance measure. To obtain a complete understanding of our performance, this measure should be examined in connection with net income (loss) determined in accordance with GAAP. Since the items excluded from this measure are significant components in understanding and assessing financial performance under GAAP, this measure should not be considered to be an alternative to net income (loss) or any other measures derived in accordance with GAAP as a measure of our operating performance or profitability. Exclusion of items in our non-GAAP presentation should not be construed as an inference that these items are unusual, infrequent or non-recurring. Other companies, including other companies in the education industry, may calculate EBITDA differently than we do, limiting its usefulness as a comparative measure across companies. Investors are encouraged to use GAAP measures when evaluating our financial performance.

EBITDA reconciles to net income (loss) as follows (in thousands):
  Year Ended September 30,
  2020 2019 2018
Net income (loss) $ 8,008  $ (7,868) $ (32,682)
Interest (income) expense, net (1,142) 1,729  1,885 
Income tax (benefit) expense (10,602) 203  (3,015)
Depreciation and amortization (1)
13,150  17,291  17,074 
EBITDA $ 9,414  $ 11,355  $ (16,738)

(1) Includes depreciation of training equipment obtained in exchange for services of $1.3 million, $1.4 million and $1.4 million for the years ended September 30, 2020, 2019 and 2018, respectively.
Liquidity and Capital Resources
    
Based on past performance and current expectations, we believe that our cash flows from operations, cash on hand and short-term investments will satisfy our working capital needs, capital expenditures, commitments and other liquidity requirements associated with our existing operations, as well as the expansion of programs at existing campuses through the next 12 months. Our cash position is available to fund strategic long-term growth initiatives, including opening additional metro campuses in new markets and the creation of new programs, such as welding, in existing markets with under-utilized campus facilities. We had no line of credit or other long-term debt as of September 30, 2020.

Our aggregate cash and cash equivalents were $76.8 million as of September 30, 2020, an increase of $11.4 million from September 30, 2019. Additionally, we had short-term held-to-maturity investments of $38.1 million as of September 30, 2020. There were no held-to-maturity investments as of September 30, 2019.

We believe that additional strategic use of our cash resources may include funding new campuses or new programs in our existing campuses, purchase of real estate assets, consideration of strategic acquisitions, the repurchase of common stock, subsidizing funding alternatives for our students, and other potential uses of cash. To the extent that potential acquisitions are large enough to require financing beyond cash from operations, cash and cash equivalents, and short-term investments, or we need capital to fund operations, new campus openings or expansion of programs at existing campuses, we may enter into a credit facility, issue debt or issue additional equity.
47



On February 20, 2020, we entered into an Underwriting Agreement with B. Riley FBR, Inc., as representative of the several underwriters named therein, to issue and sell an aggregate of 6,782,610 shares of our common stock, par value $0.0001 per share, in a public offering, at a price to the public of $7.75 per share, pursuant to a registration statement on Form S-3 (Registration No. 333-236146) and the accompanying prospectus, including the related prospectus supplement, filed with the SEC (the “Offering”). The Offering closed on February 25, 2020. The net proceeds from the Offering were approximately $49.2 million, after deducting underwriting discounts and offering expenses. We invested a portion of the net proceeds from the Offering in held-to-maturity securities, which primarily consist of corporate bonds from large cap industrial and selected financial companies with a minimum credit rating of A. We intend to use the proceeds for working capital, capital expenditures, and other general corporate purposes, which may include the addition of new campuses, the expansion of existing programs and the development of new programs, and the purchase of real property and campus infrastructure. We may also use a portion of the net proceeds to fund potential strategic acquisitions of complementary businesses, assets, services or technologies. See Note 15 of the notes to our Consolidated Financial Statements within Part II, Item 8 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K for further discussion of the Offering.

On June 9, 2016, our board of directors voted to eliminate the quarterly cash dividend on our common stock. On June 24, 2016, we issued 700,000 shares of Series A Preferred Stock for a total purchase price of $70.0 million. The proceeds from the offering were used to fund strategic initiatives to drive growth including the transformation plan, expansion to new markets with metro campuses and the creation of new programs in existing markets with under-utilized campus facilities. We paid preferred stock cash dividends of $5.3 million during the years ended September 30, 2020, 2019, and 2018, respectively.

Our principal source of liquidity is operating cash flows and existing cash and cash equivalents. A majority of our revenues are derived from Title IV Programs and various veterans benefits programs. Federal regulations dictate the timing of disbursements of funds under Title IV Programs. Students must apply for new funding for each academic year consisting of thirty-week periods. Loan funds are generally provided in two disbursements for each academic year. The first disbursement for first-time borrowers is usually received 30 days after the start of a student’s academic year and the second disbursement is typically received at the beginning of the sixteenth week from the start of the student’s academic year. Under our proprietary loan program, we bear all credit and collection risk and students are not required to begin repayment until six months after the student completes or withdraws from his or her program. These factors, together with the timing of when our students begin their programs, affect our operating cash flow.

As discussed in more detail in Note 21 of the notes to our Consolidated Financial Statements within Part II, Item 8 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K, during fiscal 2020 we were granted approximately $33.0 million in HEERF funds under the CARES Act, with $16.5 million exclusively for emergency financial aid grants to students impacted by COVID-19 and $16.5 million to cover institutional costs associated with significant changes to the delivery of instruction due to coronavirus. As of September 30, 2020, we have awarded all $16.5 million designated for student grants. During the year ended September 30, 2020, we drew down $13.9 million of the institutional funds into our operating cash account as partial reimbursement for the $15.7 million of eligible costs incurred during fiscal 2020. As of September 30, 2020, $2.7 million remained in our G5 account with the ED and is not included in our “Cash and cash equivalents” on our consolidated balance sheet. We drew down the remaining $1.8 million for the eligible costs incurred during the year ended September 30, 2020 in October 2020.

Operating Activities

Our net cash provided by operating activities was $11.0 million and $21.7 million for the years ended September 30, 2020 and 2019, respectively. Our net cash used in operating activities was $13.4 million for the year ended September 30, 2018.

Net income, after adjustments for non-cash items, for the year ended September 30, 2020 provided cash of $48.8 million. The non-cash items included $24.3 million for amortization of right-of-use assets for operating leases, $11.8 million for depreciation and amortization expense, $2.1 million for stock based compensation expense and $1.8 million for bad debt expense.

Changes in operating assets and liabilities for the year ended September 30, 2020 used cash of $37.7 million primarily due to the following:

Changes in our operating lease liability as a result of rent payments used cash of $25.6 million.
48


The increase in receivables used cash of $13.7 million and was primarily due to the timing of Title IV disbursements and other cash receipts on behalf of our students. Due to the COVID-19 pandemic, more students took a leave of absence in fiscal 2020 and our campuses suspended operations for a period of time during the second quarter. While we have transitioned to a blended learning model, the COVID-19 pandemic has impacted the pace in which students are progressing through their programs.
The increase in the income taxes receivable used cash of $7.0 million and was primarily attributable to the CARES Act, which allowed us to carryback NOLs from fiscal 2019 and fiscal 2018.
The decrease in deferred revenue used cash of $2.2 million and was primarily attributable to the timing of student starts, the number of students in school and where they were at period end in relations to completion of their program at September 30, 2020 as compared to September 30, 2019. We had deferred revenue of $6.1 million during fiscal 2020 due to students retaking courses that were previously completed and the additional time needed to complete in-person catch-up labs that were unable to be completed during the time the campuses were closed due to the COVID-19 pandemic.
The increase in accounts payable and accrued expenses provided cash of $7.0 million primarily related to the timing of payments to vendors and bonus accruals.

Net loss, after adjustments for non-cash items, for the year ended September 30, 2019 provided cash of $11.1 million. The non-cash items included $13.2 million for depreciation and amortization expense, $2.7 million for amortization of assets subject to financing obligations, $1.4 million for stock-based compensation expense, and $1.2 million for bad debt expense.

Changes in operating assets and liabilities for the year ended September 30, 2019 provided cash of $10.7 million primarily due to the following:

The increase in deferred revenue provided cash of $4.7 million and was primarily attributable to the timing of student starts, the number of students in school and where they were at period end in relation to completion of their program at September 30, 2019 as compared to September 30, 2018.
The decrease in prepaid expenses and other current assets provided cash of $3.2 million primarily due to a decrease in prepaid rent.
The increase in accounts payable and accrued expenses provided cash of $2.9 million primarily related to the timing of payments to vendors.
The increase in receivables used cash of $1.5 million and was primarily attributable to the timing of Title IV disbursements and other cash receipts on behalf of our students.

Net loss, after adjustments for non-cash items, for the year ended September 30, 2018 used cash of $15.5 million. The non-cash items included $13.0 million for depreciation and amortization expense, $2.7 million for amortization of assets subject to financing obligations, $1.8 million for stock-based compensation expense, $1.5 million for bad debt expense, and $1.2 million for goodwill impairment expense.

Changes in operating assets and liabilities for the year ended September 30, 2018 provided cash of $2.2 million primarily due to the following:

The increase in deferred rent liability provided cash of $5.1 million and was primarily relating to the Bloomfield, New Jersey campus, partially offset by amortization of the deferred rent balance associated with our home office lease.
The increase in accounts payable and accrued expenses provided cash of $3.9 million primarily related to changes in our graduate-based incentive compensation program for our admissions representatives.
The change in notes receivable provided cash of $3.4 million and was due to payments received on loans exceeding new loan originations.
The decrease in deferred revenue used cash of $5.7 million and was primarily attributable to the timing of student starts, the number of students in school and where they were at period end in relation to completion of their program at September 30, 2018 compared to September 30, 2017.
The increase in receivables used cash of $2.7 million and was primarily attributable to the timing of Title IV disbursements and other cash receipts on behalf of our students.
The increase in prepaid expenses and other current assets used cash of $1.6 million primarily related to the timing of the payment made for general invoices compared to the prior year.

49


Investing Activities

For the year ended September 30, 2020, net cash used in investing activities was $45.8 million. The cash outflow was primarily related to the net purchase of $38.4 million in held-to-maturity investments with a portion of the proceeds received from the Offering. Net cash used in investing activities was also impacted by purchases of property and equipment of $9.3 million which includes capital expenditures for the Houston, Texas and Long Beach, California welding program expansions.

For the year ended September 30, 2019, net cash used in investing activities was $6.2 million, primarily related to the purchase of property and equipment, primarily for our Dallas/Ft. Worth, Texas campus for welding program expansion, and new and replacement training equipment for ongoing operations and consolidation efforts at our Houston, Texas campus.

For the year ended September 30, 2018, cash provided by investing activities was $27.1 million. We had cash inflows of $40.9 million from proceeds received from sales of trading securities and $7.7 million from proceeds received upon the maturity of our investments. We had cash outflows of $20.6 million related to the purchases of new training equipment for our Bloomfield, New Jersey campus and replacement training equipment for our ongoing operations.

Financing Activities

For the year ended September 30, 2020, net cash provided by financing activities was $43.1 million and related primarily to the net proceeds received from the Offering of $49.2 million, partially offset by our semi-annual payments of preferred stock dividends of $5.3 million.

For the year ended September 30, 2019, net cash used in financing activities was $7.2 million and related primarily to the semi-annual payments of preferred stock dividends of $5.3 million and payments of financing obligations of $1.3 million.

For the year ended September 30, 2018, net cash used in financing activities was $6.6 million and related primarily to the semi-annual payments of preferred stock dividends of $5.3 million and payments of financing obligations of $1.1 million.

Share Repurchase Program

On December 20, 2011, our board of directors authorized the repurchase of up to $25.0 million of our common stock in the open market or through privately negotiated transactions. The timing and actual number of shares purchased will depend on a variety of factors such as price, corporate and regulatory requirements, and prevailing market conditions. We may terminate or limit the share repurchase program at any time without prior notice. The last stock repurchase under this stock repurchase program was during fiscal 2015. As of September 30, 2020, we have repurchased 1,677,570 shares at an average price per share of $9.09 and a total cost of approximately $15.3 million under this program. Under the terms of the Certificate of Designations, stock purchases under this program require the approval of a majority of the voting power of the Series A Preferred Stock.

Contractual Obligations

The following table sets forth in thousands, as of September 30, 2020, the aggregate amounts of our significant contractual obligations and commitments with definitive payment terms that will require cash outlays in the future.

Payments Due by Period
Less than 1-3 3-5 More than
Total 1 year years years 5 years
Operating leases, net of sublease income (1)
$ 192,815  $ 28,212  $ 46,012  $ 32,457  $ 86,134 
Finance leases 268  135  133  —  — 
Purchase obligations (2)
8,582  1,399  2,515  2,813  1,855 
Total contractual commitments $ 201,665  $ 29,746  $ 48,660  $ 35,270  $ 87,989 

(1)Minimum rental commitments. These amounts do not include property taxes, insurance or ordinary course recurring repairs and maintenance.
50



(2)Includes all agreements to purchase goods or services of either a fixed or minimum quantity that are enforceable and legally binding. Employment contracts, minimum payments under licensing and royalty agreements and purchase orders outstanding as of September 30, 2020 are included. In the ordinary course of business, we enter into forward purchase commitments for service agreements for general operations and advertising.

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

Each of our campuses must be authorized by the applicable state education agency in which the campus is located to operate and to grant certificates, diplomas or degrees to its students. Our campuses are subject to extensive, ongoing regulation by each of these states. Additionally, our campuses are required to be authorized by the applicable state education agencies of certain other states in which our campuses recruit students. Our insurers issue surety bonds for us on behalf of our campuses and admissions representatives with multiple states to maintain authorization to conduct our business. We are obligated to reimburse our insurers for any surety bonds that are paid by the insurers. As of September 30, 2020, the total face amount of these surety bonds was approximately $16.8 million.

Related Party Transactions

Information concerning certain related party transactions is included in Note 10 of the notes to our Consolidated Financial Statements within Part II, Item 8 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

For a description of additional information regarding related party transactions, see the information included in our proxy statement for the 2021 Annual Meeting of Stockholders under the heading “Certain Relationships and Related Transactions.”

Seasonality

Our operating results normally fluctuate as a result of seasonal variations in our business, principally due to changes in total student population and costs associated with opening or expanding our campuses. Our student population varies as a result of new student enrollments, graduations and student attrition. Historically, we have had lower student populations in our third quarter than in the remainder of our year because fewer students are enrolled during the summer months. Additionally, we have had higher student populations in our fourth quarter than in the remainder of the year because more students enroll during this period. Our expenses, however, do not vary significantly with changes in student population and revenues and, as a result, such expenses do not fluctuate significantly on a quarterly basis. We expect quarterly fluctuations in operating results to continue as a result of seasonal enrollment patterns. Such patterns may change, however, as a result of new school openings, new program introductions, increased enrollments of adult students or acquisitions. Furthermore, our revenues for the first quarter ending December 31 are impacted by the closure of our campuses for a week in December for a holiday break and during which we do not earn revenue.

Revenues
(Dollars shown in thousands) Year Ended September 30,
2020 2019 2018
Three Month Period Ending: Amount Percent Amount Percent Amount Percent
December 31 $ 87,234  29.0  % $ 83,050  25.1  % $ 81,156  25.6  %
March 31 82,717  27.5  % 81,746  24.7  % 80,663  25.5  %
June 30 54,483  18.1  % 79,042  23.8  % 74,890  23.6  %
September 30 76,327  25.4  % 87,666  26.4  % 80,256  25.3  %
  Fiscal year $ 300,761  100.0  % $ 331,504  100.0  % $ 316,965  100.0  %

The decline in revenues from December 31, 2019 to June 30, 2020 was primarily due to the impact of the COVID-19 pandemic as a higher number of students went on leave of absence. Additionally, timing of revenue recognition for active students was impacted by additional time needed to complete in-person catch-up labs that were unable to be completed during the time the campuses were closed and by students retaking courses that were previously completed. The increase in revenue for the three months ended September 30, 2020 was primarily due to our successful transition of our on-campus, in-person education model to a blended training model that combines instructor-facilitated online teaching and demonstrations
51


with hands-on labs. During the year ended September 30, 2020, the COVID-19 pandemic impacted our financials throughout each of the three months ended March 31, 2020, June 30, 2020, and September 30, 2020, and therefore are not comparative for seasonality effects.

The increase in revenues for each of the three months ended December 31, 2018, March 31, 2019, June 30, 2019 and September 30, 2019, as compared to the same periods in fiscal 2018, was primarily due to an increase in our student population during fiscal 2019.

Income (Loss) from Operations
(Dollars shown in thousands) Year Ended September 30,
2020 2019 2018
Three Month Period Ending: Amount Percent Amount Percent Amount Percent
December 31 $ 4,254  (109.9) % $ (7,205) 92.4  % $ (3,604) 10.2  %
March 31 (499) 12.9  % (5,580) 71.5  % (8,820) 25.0  %
June 30 (13,779) 356.0  % (455) 5.8  % (11,800) 33.5  %
September 30 6,153  (159.0) % 5,438  (69.7) % (11,051) 31.3  %
Fiscal year $ (3,871) 100.0  % $ (7,802) 100.0  % $ (35,275) 100.0  %

During the year ended September 30, 2020, the COVID-19 pandemic impacted our financials throughout each of the three months ended March 31, 2020, June 30, 2020 and September 30, 2020, and therefore, are not comparative for seasonality effects. Management's continued cost control efforts contributed to the improvement in income (loss) from operations for the each of the three months ended March 31, 2019, June 30, 2019 and September 30, 2019, as compared to the same periods in fiscal 2018.

Effect of Inflation

To date, inflation has not had a significant effect on our operations.

Critical Accounting Estimates

Our discussion of our financial condition and results of operations is based upon our financial statements, which have been prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States, or GAAP. During the preparation of these financial statements, we are required to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, revenues and expenses and related disclosures of contingent assets and liabilities. On an ongoing basis, we evaluate our estimates and assumptions, including those related to revenue recognition, our proprietary loan program, allowance for uncollectible accounts, goodwill recoverability, self-insurance claim liabilities, income taxes and contingencies. We base our estimates on historical experience and on various other assumptions that we believe are reasonable under the circumstances. The results of our analysis form the basis for making judgments about the carrying values of assets and liabilities that are not readily apparent from other sources. Actual results may differ from these estimates under different assumptions or conditions, and the impact of such differences may be material to our consolidated financial statements.

Our significant accounting policies are discussed in Note 2 of the notes to our Consolidated Financial Statements within Part II, Item 8 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. We believe that the following accounting estimates are the most critical to aid in fully understanding and evaluating our reported financial results, and they require management’s most subjective and complex judgments in estimating the effect of inherent uncertainties.

Revenue recognition

Revenues consist primarily of student tuition and fees derived from the programs we provide after reductions are made for discounts and scholarships that we sponsor and for refunds for students who withdraw from our programs prior to specified dates. We apply the five-step model outlined in Accounting Standards Codification Topic 606, Revenue from Contracts from Customers (“ASC 606”). Tuition and fee revenue is recognized ratably over the term of the course or program offered. Approximately 99%, 99% and 98% of our revenues for each of the years ended September 30, 2020, 2019 and 2018,
52


respectively, consisted of gross tuition. The majority of our core programs are designed to be completed in 36 to 90 weeks, and our advanced training programs range from 12 to 23 weeks in duration. We supplement our revenues with sales of textbooks and program supplies and other revenues, which are recognized as the transfer of goods or services occurs. Deferred revenue represents the excess of tuition and fee payments received as compared to tuition and fees earned and is reflected as a current liability in our consolidated balance sheets because it is expected to be earned within the next 12 months.

During the year ended September 30, 2020, due to the COVID-19 pandemic, we transitioned our on-campus, in-person education model to a blended training model that combines instructor-facilitated online teaching and demonstrations with hands-on labs. We continue to recognize revenue ratably over the term of the course or program offered. However, revenue recognition for active students during the year ended September 30, 2020 was impacted by students retaking courses that were previously completed and the additional time needed to complete in-person catch-up labs that were unable to be completed during the time the campuses were closed due to COVID-19. As of September 30, 2020 we had deferred revenue of $6.1 million related to students who were only attending courses online or with catch-up labs still outstanding. We do not recognize revenue while a student is on a leave of absence.

Through our proprietary loan program, we, in substance, provide the students who participate in this program with extended payment terms for a portion of their tuition. Based on historical collection rates, we can demonstrate that a portion of these loans are collectible, which results in a change in accounting due to our adoption of ASC 606 on October 1, 2017. Accordingly, we recognize tuition and loan origination fees financed by the loan and any related interest revenue under the effective interest method required under the loan based on this collection rate.

Other

We provide dealer technician training or instructor staffing services to manufacturers. Revenues are recognized as transfer of the services occurs.
Proprietary Loan Program

In order to provide funding for students who are not able to fully finance the cost of their education under traditional governmental financial aid programs, commercial loan programs or other alternative sources, we established a private loan program with a bank.

Under the terms of the proprietary loan program, the bank originates loans for our students who meet our specific credit criteria with the related proceeds used exclusively to fund a portion of their tuition. We then purchase all such loans from the bank at least monthly and assume all of the related credit risk. The loans bear interest at market rates ranging from approximately 7% to 10%; however, principal and interest payments are not required until six months after the student completes or withdraws from his or her program. After the deferral period, monthly principal and interest payments are required over the related term of the loan. The repayment term is up to 10 years.

Under ASC 606, the portion of tuition revenue related to the proprietary loan program is considered a form of variable consideration. We estimate the amount we ultimately expect to collect from the portion of tuition that is funded by the proprietary loan program, resulting in a note receivable. Estimating the collection rate requires significant management judgment. The estimated amount is determined at the inception of the contract and we recognize the related revenue as the student progresses through school. Each reporting period, we update our assessment of the variable consideration associated with the proprietary loan program.

Allowance for uncollectible accounts

We maintain an allowance for uncollectible accounts for estimated losses resulting from the inability, failure or refusal of our students to make required payments. We offer a variety of payment plans to help students pay that portion of their education expenses not covered by financial aid programs or alternate fund sources, which are unsecured and not guaranteed.

We use estimates that are subjective and require judgment in determining the allowance for doubtful accounts, which are principally based on accounts receivable, historical percentages of uncollectible accounts, customer credit worthiness and changes in payment history when evaluating the adequacy of the allowance for uncollectible accounts. We also monitor and consider external factors such as changes in the economic and regulatory environment. We use an internal group of
53


collectors, augmented by third party collectors as deemed appropriate, in our collection efforts. When a student with Title IV loans withdraws, Title IV rules determine if we are required to return a portion of Title IV funds to the lender. We are then entitled to collect these funds from the students, but collection rates for these types of receivables is significantly lower than our collection rates for receivables for students who remain in our programs.

Although we believe that our allowance is adequate, if we underestimate the allowances required, additional allowances may be necessary, which would result in increased selling, general and administrative expenses in the period such determination is made.

Leases

We lease the majority of our administrative and educational facilities. ASC 842, Leases, requires lessees to recognize a right-of-use (“ROU”) asset and a lease liability on the balance sheet for substantially all leases, with the exception of short-term leases. Leases are classified as either finance or operating, with classification affecting the pattern of expense recognition in the statement of income. We adopted ASC 842 as of October 1, 2019 under a modified retrospective method without the recasting of comparative periods’ financial information.

To determine if a contract is or contains a lease, we considered whether (1) explicitly or implicitly identified assets have been deployed in the contract and (2) we obtain substantially all of the economic benefits from the use of that underlying asset and direct how and for what purpose the asset is used during the term of the contract. If we determine a contract is, or contains, a lease, we assess whether the contract contains multiple lease components. We consider a lease component to be separate from other lease components in the contract if (a) we can benefit from the right of use either on its own or together with other resources that are readily available to us and (b) the right of use is neither highly dependent on nor highly interrelated with the other right(s) to use underlying assets in the contract. In contracts involving the use of real estate, we separate the right to use land from other underlying assets unless the effect of separating the land is insignificant to the resulting lease accounting. We have elected to account for the lease and non-lease components as a single lease component.

For all leases we are a party to, the discount rate implicit in the lease was not readily determinable. Therefore, we used our incremental borrowing rate for each lease to determine the present value of the lease. We determined the incremental borrowing rate applicable to each lease through a model that represents the rate of interest we would have to pay to borrow on a collateralized basis over a similar term an amount equal to the lease payments in a similar economic environment. The incremental borrowing rate was applied to each lease based on the remaining term of the lease.

The components of lease expense are included in “Educational services and facilities” and “Selling, general and administrative” on the consolidated statement of operations, with the exception of interest on lease liabilities, which is included in “Interest expense.”

Goodwill

Goodwill represents the excess of the cost of an acquired business over the estimated fair values of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed. Goodwill is reviewed at least annually for impairment, which might result from the deterioration in the operating performance of the acquired business, adverse market conditions, adverse changes in the applicable laws or regulations and a variety of other circumstances. Any resulting impairment charge would be recognized as an expense in the period in which impairment is identified.

We perform our annual goodwill impairment assessment during the fourth quarter of each fiscal year. In performing our impairment tests, we first consider the option to assess qualitative factors to determine whether it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit or intangible, as applicable, is less than its carrying amount. If we conclude that it is more likely than not that the fair value is less than the carrying amount based on our qualitative assessment, or that a qualitative assessment should not be performed, we proceed with the quantitative impairment tests to compare the estimated fair value of the reporting unit to the carrying value of its net assets.

The process of evaluating goodwill and indefinite-lived intangibles for impairment is subjective and requires significant judgment at many points during the analysis. If we elect to perform an optional qualitative analysis, we consider many factors including, but not limited to, general economic conditions, industry and market conditions, our market capitalization, financial performance and key business drivers, long-term operating plans and potential changes to significant assumptions used in the most recent fair value analysis for the reporting unit.
54



When performing a quantitative goodwill impairment test, we generally determine the fair value of reporting units using an income-based approach consisting of a discounted cash flow valuation method. The fair value determination consists primarily of using unobservable inputs under the fair value measurement standards, and we believe our related assumptions are consistent with a reasonable market participant view while employing the concept of highest and best use of the asset.

We believe the most critical assumptions and estimates in determining the estimated fair value of our reporting units include, but are not limited to, future tuition revenues, operating costs, working capital changes, capital expenditures and a discount rate. The assumptions used in determining our expected future cash flows consider various factors such as historical operating trends particularly in student enrollment and pricing and long-term operating strategies and initiatives.

2020 Impairment Testing

Our total recorded goodwill was $8.2 million as of September 30, 2020 which resulted primarily from the acquisition of our motorcycle and marine education business in 1998 in Orlando, Florida. We completed our 2020 annual goodwill impairment tests and determined that it was more likely than not that the fair value of the reporting units exceeded the carrying value and concluded that goodwill was not impaired. As a result, we did not perform the quantitative goodwill impairment evaluation.

Self-Insurance

We are self-insured for a number of risks, including claims related to employee health care and dental care and workers’ compensation. The accounting for our self-insured plans involves estimates and judgments to determine our ultimate liability related to reported claims and claims incurred but not reported. We consider our historical experience, severity factors, actuarial analysis and existing stop loss insurance in estimating our ultimate insurance liability. If our insurance claim trends were to differ significantly from our historic claim experience, we would make a corresponding adjustment to our insurance reserves.

Income taxes

We are subject to the income tax laws of the United States, which are complex and subject to different interpretations by the taxpayer and the relevant governmental taxing authorities. As a result, significant judgments and interpretations are required in determining our provision for income taxes.

Each reporting period, we estimate the likelihood that we will be able to recover our deferred tax assets, which represent timing differences in the recognition of revenue and certain tax deductions for accounting and tax purposes. The realization of deferred tax assets is dependent, in part, upon future taxable income. In assessing the need for a valuation allowance, we consider all available evidence, including our historical profitability and projections of future taxable income. If, based on the weight of available evidence, it is more likely than not the deferred tax assets will not be realized, we record a valuation allowance. Such valuation allowance is maintained on our deferred tax assets until sufficient positive evidence exists to support its reversal in future periods. The weight given to the positive and negative evidence is commensurate with the extent to which the evidence may be objectively verified. Significant judgment is required to determine if, and the extent to which, valuation allowances should be recorded against deferred tax assets. Changes in the valuation allowance are included in our statement of operations as a charge or credit to income tax benefit (expense).

As a result of our assessment, income tax benefit (expense) within our statements of operations was impacted by a decrease of $6.1 million and an increase of $1.5 million in the valuation allowance during the years ended September 30, 2020 and 2019, respectively. The amount of the deferred tax assets considered realizable, however, could be adjusted in future periods if estimates of future taxable income during the carryforward period are increased, if objective negative evidence in the form of cumulative losses is no longer present and if additional weight may be given to subjective evidence such as our projections for growth. We will continue to evaluate our valuation allowance in future periods for any change in circumstances that causes a change in judgment about the realizability of the deferred tax assets.

Although we believe that our estimates are reasonable, changes in tax laws or our interpretation of tax laws, and the outcome of future tax audits could significantly impact the amounts provided for income taxes in our consolidated financial statements. Additionally, actual operating results and the underlying amount and category of income in future years could render our current assessment of recoverable deferred tax assets inaccurate.

55


Contingencies

In the ordinary conduct of our business, we are subject to occasional lawsuits, investigations and claims, including, but not limited to, claims involving students and graduates and routine employment matters. When we are aware of a claim or potential claim, we assess the likelihood of any loss or exposure. If it is probable that a loss will result and the amount of the loss can be reasonably estimated, we record a liability for the loss. If the loss is not probable or the amount of the loss cannot be reasonably estimated, we disclose the nature of the specific claim if the likelihood of a potential loss is reasonably possible and the amount involved is material. Generally, we expense legal fees as incurred. There can be no assurance that the ultimate outcome of any of the lawsuits, investigations or claims pending against us will not have a material adverse effect on our financial condition or results of operations.

Recent Accounting Pronouncements

Information concerning recently issued accounting pronouncements which are not yet effective is included in Note 3 of the notes to our Consolidated Financial Statements within Part II, Item 8 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. As indicated in Note 3, we are still evaluating the impact of the recently issued accounting pronouncements on our financial statements.

ITEM 7A. QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK

Our principal exposure to market risk relates to changes in interest rates. We invest our cash and cash equivalents in money market funds and short-term corporate and municipal bonds. As of September 30, 2020, we held $76.8 million in cash and cash equivalents and $38.1 million in short-term held-to-maturity securities. For the year ended September 30, 2020, we earned interest income of $1.2 million. We do not believe that reasonably possible changes in interest rates will have a material effect on our financial position, results of operations or cash flows.

As of September 30, 2020, we did not have any short-term or long-term borrowings.

ITEM 8.    FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA
The following financial statements of the Company and its subsidiaries are included below on pages F-2 to F-50 of this report:
  Page
Number

ITEM 9. CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE

None.

ITEM 9A. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES
Disclosure Controls and Procedures
Under the supervision and with the participation of our management, including our Chief Executive Officer and our Chief Financial Officer, we have evaluated the effectiveness of the design and operation of our disclosure controls and procedures (as such term is defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) under the Exchange Act) as of September 30, 2020, pursuant to Exchange Act Rule 13a-15. Based upon that evaluation, the Chief Executive Officer and the Chief Financial Officer
56


concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures as of September 30, 2020 were effective in ensuring that (i) information required to be disclosed by the Company in the reports that it files or submits under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized and reported, within the time periods specified in the SEC’s rules and forms and (ii) information required to be disclosed by the Company in the reports that it files or submits under the Exchange Act is accumulated and communicated to the Company’s management, including its principal executive and principal financial officers, or persons performing similar functions, as appropriate to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure.

Changes in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

There were no changes in our internal control over financial reporting identified in connection with the evaluation required by Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(d) or 15d-15(d) that occurred during the quarter ended September 30, 2020 that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting. As we continue the process to adopt ASU 2016-02, Leases (Topic 842), we expect that there will be additional changes in internal controls over financial reporting.

Report of Management on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting and Attestation Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting and the attestation report of our Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm with respect to the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting are included on pages F-2 and F-3, respectively, of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

Limitations on Effectiveness of Controls and Procedures
Our management, including our Chief Executive Officer and our Chief Financial Officer, does not expect that our disclosure controls and procedures or our internal controls over financial reporting will prevent all error and all fraud. A control system, no matter how well conceived and operated, can provide only reasonable, not absolute, assurance that the objectives of the control system are met. Further, the design of a control system must reflect the fact that there are resource constraints, and the benefits of controls must be considered relative to their costs. Because of the inherent limitations in all control systems, no evaluation of controls can provide absolute assurance that all control issues, misstatements, errors and instances of fraud, if any, within our company have been or will be prevented or detected. These inherent limitations include the realities that judgments in decision-making can be faulty and that breakdowns can occur because of simple error or mistake. Controls also can be circumvented by the individual acts of some persons, by collusion of two or more people or by management override of the controls. The design of any system of controls is based in part on certain assumptions about the likelihood of future events, and there can be no assurance that any design will succeed in achieving its stated goals under all potential future conditions. Projections of any evaluation of controls effectiveness to future periods are subject to risks that internal controls may become inadequate as a result of changes in conditions, or through the deterioration of the degree of compliance with policies or procedures.

Management’s Certifications

The Company has filed as exhibits to its Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended September 30, 2020, filed with the SEC, the certifications of the Chief Executive Officer and the Chief Financial Officer of the Company required by Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
The Company has submitted to the NYSE the most recent Annual Chief Executive Officer Certification as required by Section 303A.12(a) of the NYSE Listed Company Manual.
ITEM 9B. OTHER INFORMATION
None.


57


PART III

ITEM 10. DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
Below is a list of our Executive Officers and Board of Directors as of the year ended September 30, 2020:
Executive Officer Position
Jerome A. Grant Chief Executive Officer
Troy R. Anderson Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer
Sherrell E. Smith Executive Vice President, Campus Operations & Services
Bart H. Fesperman Senior Vice President, Chief Commercial Officer
Todd A. Hitchcock Senior Vice President, Chief Strategy and Transformation Officer
Christopher E. Kevane Senior Vice President, Chief Legal Officer
Sonia C. Mason Senior Vice President, Chief Human Resources Officer
Eric A. Severson Senior Vice President, Admissions
Lori B. Smith Senior Vice President, Chief Information Officer
Director Position
Robert T. DeVincenzi Chairman of the Board, Universal Technical Institute, Inc.; Principal Partner, Lupine Venture Group
David A. Blaszkiewicz President and Chief Executive Officer, Invest Detroit
George W. Brochick Executive Vice President - Strategic Development, Penske Automotive Group, Inc.
Jerome A. Grant Chief Executive Officer, Universal Technical Institute, Inc.
LTG (R) William J. Lennox Former Superindendent of the United States Military Academy at West Point; Chief Executive Officer, Lennox Strategies, LLC
Kimberly J. McWaters Former President and Chief Executive Officer, Universal Technical Institute, Inc.
Dr. Roderick R. Paige(1)
Former United States Secretary of Education
Christopher S. Shackelton Managing Partner, Coliseum Capital Management, LLC
Linda J. Srere Former President, Young and Rubicam Advertising
Kenneth R. Trammell Former Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer, Tenneco Inc.
John C. White(1)
Former Chairman of the Board, Universal Technical Institute, Inc.

(1) Effective as of November 30, 2020, Dr. Paige and Mr. White each voluntarily retired from our board of directors.

The information required by this Item is incorporated by reference from our Proxy Statement to be filed in connection with our 2021 Annual Meeting of Stockholders within 120 days after the end of fiscal year ended September 30, 2020.
ITEM 11. EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

The information required by this Item is incorporated by reference from our Proxy Statement to be filed in connection with our 2021 Annual Meeting of Stockholders within 120 days after the end of fiscal year ended September 30, 2020.

ITEM 12. SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS

The information required by this Item is incorporated by reference from our Proxy Statement to be filed in connection with our 2021 Annual Meeting of Stockholders within 120 days after the end of fiscal year ended September 30, 2020.

58


ITEM 13. CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE

The information required by this Item is incorporated by reference from our Proxy Statement to be filed in connection with our 2021 Annual Meeting of Stockholders within 120 days after the end of fiscal year ended September 30, 2020.

ITEM 14. PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES

The information required by this Item is incorporated by reference from our Proxy Statement to be filed in connection with our 2021 Annual Meeting of Stockholders within 120 days after the end of fiscal year ended September 30, 2020.

59


PART IV

ITEM 15. EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES
(a) Documents filed as part of this Annual Report on Form 10-K:
(1) The financial statements required to be included in this Annual Report on Form 10-K are included in Item 8 of this Report.
(2) All other schedules have been omitted because they are not required, are not applicable, or the required information is shown on the financial statements or the notes thereto.
(3) Exhibits:

Exhibit Number Description
3.1
3.2
3.3
3.4
4.1
4.2
4.3
4.4
4.5
4.6+
10.1*
10.2*
10.3*
10.4.1*
10.4.2*
60


Exhibit Number Description
10.4.3*
10.4.4*
10.4.5*
10.4.6*
10.5
10.6
10.7*
10.8*
10.11.1*
10.11.2*
10.13*
10.14*
10.15
10.16*
10.17*
21.1+
23.1+
24.1
31.1+
31.2+
32.1+
32.2+
101.INS XBRL Instance Document.
101.SCH XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document.
101.CAL XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document.
101.DEF XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase Document.
61


Exhibit Number Description
101.LAB XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document.
101.PRE XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document.

* Indicates a contract with management or compensatory plan or arrangement.
+ Filed herewith.

62


SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.


Date: December 3, 2020 UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC.
By: /s/ Jerome A. Grant
Jerome A. Grant, Chief Executive Officer

POWER OF ATTORNEY
KNOW ALL MEN BY THESE PRESENTS, that each person whose signature appears below constitutes and appoints Jerome A. Grant and Troy R. Anderson, or either of them, as his true and lawful attorneys-in-fact and agents, with full power of substitution and resubstitution, for him and in his name, place and stead, in any and all capacities, to sign any and all amendments to this Annual Report on Form 10-K and any documents related to this report and filed pursuant to the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, and to file the same, with all exhibits thereto, and other documents in connection therewith, with the Securities and Exchange Commission, granting unto said attorneys-in-fact and agents, full power and authority to do and perform each and every act and thing requisite and necessary to be done in connection therewith as fully to all intents and purposes as he might or could do in person, hereby ratifying and confirming all that said attorneys-in-fact and agents, or their substitute or substitutes may lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue hereof.
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

SIGNATURE TITLE DATE
/s/ Jerome A. Grant
Chief Executive Officer (Principal Executive Officer) December 3, 2020
Jerome A. Grant
/s/ Troy R. Anderson
Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial Officer and Principal Accounting Officer) December 3, 2020
Troy R. Anderson
/s/ Robert T. DeVincenzi
Chairman of the Board December 3, 2020
Robert T. DeVincenzi
/s/ David A. Blaszkiewicz
Director December 3, 2020
David A. Blaszkiewicz
/s/ George W. Brochick Director December 3, 2020
George W. Brochick
/s/ William J. Lennox, Jr.
Director December 3, 2020
William J. Lennox, Jr.
/s/ Kimberly J. McWaters
Director December 3, 2020
Kimberly J. McWaters
63


/s/ Christopher S. Shackelton
Director December 3, 2020
Christopher S. Shackelton
/s/ Linda J. Srere
Director December 3, 2020
Linda J. Srere
/s/ Kenneth R. Trammell
Director December 3, 2020
Kenneth R. Trammell

64



UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
  Page
Number
F- 1



MANAGEMENT’S REPORT ON INTERNAL CONTROL OVER FINANCIAL REPORTING
Our management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting for the company and for assessing the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting as such term is defined in Rule 13a-15(f) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended. Internal control over financial reporting is a process to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of our financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States.
Internal control over financial reporting includes policies and procedures that pertain to maintaining records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect our transactions and dispositions of the company’s assets; providing reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of our financial statements in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States; providing reasonable assurance that receipts and expenditures of company assets are made in accordance with management and director authorization; and providing reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of company assets that could have a material effect on our financial statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to risks that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
Management conducted an evaluation of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting based on the framework established in “Internal Control — Integrated Framework (2013)” issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. Based on this evaluation, management concluded that the Company’s internal control over financial reporting was effective as of September 30, 2020.
The effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of September 30, 2020 has been audited by Deloitte & Touche LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, as stated in their report which appears herein.
F- 2


REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

To the shareholders and the Board of Directors of Universal Technical Institute, Inc.

Opinion on Internal Control over Financial Reporting

We have audited the internal control over financial reporting of Universal Technical Institute, Inc. and subsidiaries (the “Company”) as of September 30, 2020, based on criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). In our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of September 30, 2020, based on criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework (2013) issued by COSO.

We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB), the consolidated financial statements as of and for the year ended September 30, 2020, of the Company and our report dated December 3, 2020 expressed an unqualified opinion on those financial statements and included an explanatory paragraph regarding the Company’s change in method of accounting for leases as a result of the adoption of Accounting Standards Codification Topic 842, Leases, effective October 1, 2019.

Basis for Opinion

The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit. We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

Definition and Limitations of Internal Control over Financial Reporting

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

/s/ DELOITTE & TOUCHE LLP

Phoenix, Arizona
December 3, 2020

F- 3


REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

To the shareholders and the Board of Directors of Universal Technical Institute, Inc.

Opinion on the Financial Statements

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Universal Technical Institute, Inc. and subsidiaries (the "Company") as of September 30, 2020 and 2019, the related consolidated statements of operations, of shareholders’ equity, and of cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended September 30, 2020, and the related notes (“collectively referred to financial statements”). In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company as of September 30, 2020 and 2019, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended September 30, 2020, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.

We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB), the Company's internal control over financial reporting as of September 30, 2020, based on criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission and our report dated December 3, 2020, expressed an unqualified opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

Change in Accounting Principle

As discussed in Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements, effective October 1, 2019, the Company adopted FASB ASC 842, Leases, using the modified retrospective approach.

Basis for Opinion

These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company's financial statements based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud. Our audits included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. Our audits also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial statements. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

/s/ DELOITTE & TOUCHE LLP

Phoenix, Arizona
December 3, 2020

We have served as the Company's auditor since 2015.
F- 4


UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
(In thousands, except par value and per share amounts)
September 30, 2020 September 30, 2019
Assets
Cash and cash equivalents $ 76,803  $ 65,442 
Restricted cash 12,116  15,113 
Held-to-maturity investments 38,055  — 
Receivables, net 35,411  17,937 
Notes receivable, current portion 5,184  5,227 
Prepaid expenses 6,121  7,054 
Other current assets 6,489  7,331 
Total current assets 180,179  118,104 
Property and equipment, net 72,743  104,126 
Goodwill 8,222  8,222 
Notes receivable, less current portion 27,609  29,852 
Right-of-use assets for operating leases 144,663  — 
Other assets 8,565  10,222 
Total assets $ 441,981  $ 270,526 
Liabilities and Shareholders’ Equity
Accounts payable and accrued expenses $ 51,891  $ 45,878 
Deferred revenue 40,694  42,886 
Accrued tool sets 3,148  2,586 
Operating lease liability, current portion 23,666  — 
Financing obligation, current —  1,554 
Other current liabilities 2,241  3,940 
Total current liabilities 121,640  96,844 
Deferred tax liabilities, net 674  329 
Deferred rent liability —  10,326 
Financing obligation —  39,161 
Operating lease liability 134,089  — 
Other liabilities 9,056  9,578 
Total liabilities 265,459  156,238 
Commitments and contingencies (Note 14)
Shareholders’ equity:
Common stock, $0.0001 par value, 100,000 shares authorized, 32,730 and 32,499 shares issued, and 32,647 and 25,634 shares outstanding as of September 30, 2020 and 2019, respectively
Preferred stock, $0.0001 par value, 10,000 shares authorized; 700 shares of Series A Convertible Preferred Stock issued and outstanding as of September 30, 2020 and 2019, liquidation preference of $100 per share
—  — 
Paid-in capital - common 141,002  187,493 
Paid-in capital - preferred 68,853  68,853 
Treasury stock, at cost, 82 and 6,865 shares as of September 30, 2020 and 2019, respectively
(365) (97,388)
Retained deficit (32,971) (44,673)
Total shareholders’ equity 176,522  114,288 
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity $ 441,981  $ 270,526 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.
F- 5


UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)

Year Ended September 30,
  2020 2019 2018
Revenues $ 300,761  $ 331,504  $ 316,965 
Operating expenses:
Educational services and facilities 155,932  178,317  182,589 
Selling, general and administrative 148,700  160,989  169,651 
Total operating expenses 304,632  339,306  352,240 
Loss from operations (3,871) (7,802) (35,275)
Other income (expense):
Interest income 1,152  1,491  1,425 
Interest expense (10) (3,220) (3,310)
Equity in earnings of unconsolidated affiliate —  399  385 
Other income 135  1,467  1,078 
Total other income (expense), net 1,277  137  (422)
Loss before income taxes (2,594) (7,665) (35,697)
Income tax benefit (expense) 10,602  (203) 3,015 
Net income (loss) $ 8,008  $ (7,868) $ (32,682)
Preferred stock dividends 5,264  5,250  5,250 
Income (loss) available for distribution $ 2,744  $ (13,118) $ (37,932)
Earnings per share (See Note 17):
Net income (loss) per share - basic $ 0.05  $ (0.52) $ (1.51)
Net income (loss) per share - diluted $ 0.05  $ (0.52) $ (1.51)
Weighted average number of shares outstanding:
Basic 29,812  25,438  25,115 
Diluted 30,113  25,438  25,115 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.
F- 6


UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
(In thousands)

  Common Stock Preferred Stock Paid-in
Capital - Common
Paid-in
Capital - Preferred
Treasury Stock Retained
Earnings (Deficit)
Total
Shareholders’
Equity
  Shares Amount Shares Amount Shares Amount
Balance as of September 30, 2017 31,872  $ 700  $ —  $ 185,140  $ 68,853  (6,865) $ (97,388) $ (30,832) $ 125,776 
Adjustment for the adoption of ASC 606 —  —  —  —  —  —  —  —  37,209  37,209 
Net loss —  —  —  —  —  —  —  —  (32,682) (32,682)
Issuance of common stock under employee plans 379  —  —  —  —  —  —  —  —  — 
Shares withheld for payroll taxes (82) —  —  —  (223) —  —  —  —  (223)
Stock-based compensation —  —  —  —  1,815  —  —  —  —  1,815 
Preferred stock cash dividends declared —  —  —  —  —  —  —  —  (5,250) (5,250)
Balance as of September 30, 2018 32,169  $ 700  $ —  $ 186,732  $ 68,853  (6,865) $ (97,388) $ (31,555) $ 126,645 
Net loss —  —  —  —  —  —  —  —  (7,868) (7,868)
Issuance of common stock under employee plans 465  —  —  —  —  —  —  —  —  — 
Shares withheld for payroll taxes (135) —  —  —  (629) —  —  —  —  (629)
Stock-based compensation —  —  —  —  1,390  —  —  —  —  1,390 
Preferred stock cash dividends declared —  —  —  —  —  —  —  —  (5,250) (5,250)
Balance as of September 30, 2019 32,499  $ 700  $ —  $ 187,493  $ 68,853  (6,865) $ (97,388) $ (44,673) $ 114,288 
Adjustment for the adoption of ASC 842 —  —  —  —  —  —  —  —  8,958  8,958 
Net income —  —  —  —  —  —  —  —  8,008  8,008 
Issuance of common stock under employee plans 328  —  —  —  —  —  —  —  —  — 
Shares withheld for payroll taxes (97) —  —  —  (698) —  —  —  —  (698)
Stock-based compensation —  —  —  —  2,077  —  —  —  —  2,077 
Shares issued for equity offering —  —  —  —  (47,870) —  6,783  97,023  —  49,153 
Preferred stock cash dividends declared —  —  —  —  —  —  —  —  (5,264) (5,264)
Balance as of September 30, 2020 32,730  $ 700  $ —  $ 141,002  $ 68,853  (82) $ (365) $ (32,971) $ 176,522 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.
F- 7


UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
(In thousands)
Year Ended September 30,
  2020 2019 2018
Cash flows from operating activities:
Net income (loss) $ 8,008  $ (7,868) $ (32,682)
Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash provided by (used in) operating activities:
Depreciation and amortization 11,804  13,222  13,006 
Amortization of assets subject to financing obligation —  2,682  2,682 
Amortization of right-of-use assets for operating leases 24,273  —  — 
Goodwill and intangible asset impairment expense —  —  1,164 
Bad debt expense 1,767  1,166  1,511 
Stock-based compensation 2,077  1,390  1,815 
Deferred income taxes 345  —  (2,812)
Equity in earnings of unconsolidated affiliate —  (399) (385)
Training equipment credits earned, net 541  302  33 
Other (gains) losses, net (52) 561  122 
Changes in assets and liabilities:
Receivables (13,749) (1,483) (2,695)
Notes receivable 2,286  1,298  3,393 
Prepaid expenses and other current assets (1,016) 3,157  (1,584)
Other assets (76) 1,016  (116)
Accounts payable and accrued expenses 7,020  2,942  3,858 
Deferred revenue (2,192) 4,650  (5,663)
Income tax (receivable) payable (6,989) 166  (812)
Accrued tool sets and other current liabilities 1,863  300  1,014 
Deferred rent liability —  (1,677) 5,116 
Operating lease liability (25,617) —  — 
Other liabilities 739  321  (318)
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities 11,032  21,746  (13,353)
Cash flows from investing activities:
Purchase of property and equipment (9,262) (6,453) (20,606)
Proceeds from disposal of property and equipment 64  34  25 
Purchase of held-to-maturity investments (69,678) —  — 
Proceeds received upon maturity of investments 31,289  —  7,739 
Proceeds from life insurance policy 1,566  —  — 
Purchase of trading securities —  —  (894)
Proceeds from sales of trading securities —  —  40,902 
Capitalized costs for intangible assets —  —  (325)
Return of capital contribution from unconsolidated affiliate 261  267  291 
Net cash (used in) provided by investing activities (45,760) (6,152) 27,132 
Cash flows from financing activities:
Proceeds from equity offering 49,153  —  — 
Payment of preferred stock cash dividend (5,264) (5,250) (5,250)
Payment of financing obligation and finance leases (99) (1,319) (1,107)
Payment of payroll taxes on stock-based compensation through shares withheld (698) (629) (223)
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities 43,092  (7,198) (6,580)
Change in cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash 8,364  8,396  7,199 
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of period 65,442  58,104  50,138 
Restricted cash, beginning of period 15,113  14,055  14,822 
Cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash, beginning of period 80,555  72,159  64,960 
Cash and cash equivalents, end of period 76,803  65,442  58,104 
Restricted cash, end of period 12,116  15,113  14,055 
Cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash, end of period $ 88,919  $ 80,555  $ 72,159 
F- 8


UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS (CONTINUED)
(In thousands)

Year Ended September 30,
2020 2019 2018
Supplemental disclosure of cash flow information:
Taxes (refunded) paid $ (113) $ 37  $ 610 
Interest paid 3,220  3,310 
Training equipment obtained in exchange for services 985  772  3,240 
Depreciation of training equipment obtained in exchange for services 1,345  1,387  1,386 
Change in accrued capital expenditures during the period (490) 316  (1,042)
CARES Act funds received for student emergency grants (See Note 21) 16,565  —  — 
CARES Act funds disbursed for student emergency grants (See Note 21) (17,184) —  — 
CARES Act funds received for institutional costs (See Note 21) 13,889  —  — 
CARES Act funds for institutional costs included in Receivables, net (See Note 21) 1,797  —  — 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.
F- 9

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)

Note 1 - Business Description

Universal Technical Institute, Inc. (“we,” “us” or “our”) is the leading provider of postsecondary education for students seeking careers as professional automotive, diesel, collision repair, motorcycle and marine technicians as measured by total average full-time enrollment and graduates. We also provide programs for welders and computer numeric control (“CNC”) machining technicians. We offer certificate, diploma or degree programs at 12 campuses across the United States under the banner of several well-known brands, including Universal Technical Institute, Motorcycle Mechanics Institute, Marine Mechanics Institute and NASCAR Technical Institute. This excludes the Norwood, Massachusetts campus that was closed on July 31, 2020. We also offer manufacturer specific advanced training (“MSAT”) programs, including student-paid electives, at our campuses and manufacturer or dealer sponsored training at certain campuses and dedicated training centers. Founded in 1965, we have provided technical education for more than 55 years and have graduated more than 220,000 technicians.

We work closely with over 35 original equipment manufacturers and industry brand partners to understand their needs for qualified service professionals. Revenues generated from our schools consist primarily of tuition and fees paid by students. To pay for a substantial portion of their tuition, the majority of students rely on funds received from federal financial aid programs under Title IV Programs of the Higher Education Act of 1965, as amended (“HEA”), as well as from various veterans benefits programs. For further discussion, see Note 2 on “Summary of Significant Accounting Policies - Concentration of Risk” and Note 20 on “Government Regulation and Financial Aid.”

Note 2 - Summary of Significant Accounting Policies
Principles of Consolidation
The accompanying consolidated financial statements include the accounts of UTI and its wholly owned subsidiaries. All significant intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated.
Use of Estimates
The preparation of financial statements in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States requires management to make certain estimates and assumptions. Such estimates and assumptions affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, revenues and expenses and related disclosures of contingent assets and liabilities. On an ongoing basis, we evaluate our estimates and assumptions, including those related to revenue recognition, our proprietary loan program, allowance for uncollectible accounts, investments, property and equipment, goodwill recoverability, self-insurance claim liabilities, income taxes, contingencies and stock-based compensation. We base our estimates on historical experience and on various other assumptions that we believe are reasonable under the circumstances. The results of our analysis form the basis for making judgments about the carrying values of assets and liabilities that are not readily apparent from other sources. Actual results may differ from these estimates under different assumptions or conditions, and the impact of such differences may be material to our consolidated financial statements.
Revenue Recognition
Postsecondary education

Revenues consist primarily of student tuition and fees derived from the programs we provide after reductions are made for discounts and scholarships that we sponsor and for refunds for students who withdraw from our programs prior to specified dates. We apply the five-step model outlined in Accounting Standards Codification Topic 606, Revenue from Contracts from Customers (“ASC 606”). Tuition and fee revenue is recognized ratably over the term of the course or program offered. Approximately 99%, 99% and 98% of our revenues for each of the years ended September 30, 2020, 2019 and 2018, respectively, consisted of gross tuition. The majority of our core programs are designed to be completed in 36 to 90 weeks, and our advanced training programs range from 12 to 23 weeks in duration. We supplement our revenues with sales of textbooks and program supplies and other revenues, which are recognized as the transfer of goods or services occurs. Deferred revenue represents the excess of tuition and fee payments received as compared to tuition and fees earned and is reflected as a current liability in our consolidated balance sheets because it is expected to be earned within the next 12 months.
F- 10

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)

Through our proprietary loan program, we, in substance, provide the students who participate in this program with extended payment terms for a portion of their tuition. Based on historical collection rates, we can demonstrate that a portion of these loans are collectible. Accordingly, we recognize tuition and loan origination fees financed by the loan and any related interest revenue under the effective interest method required under the loan based on this collection rate.

Other

We provide dealer technician training or instructor staffing services to manufacturers. Revenues are recognized as transfer of the services occurs.

Proprietary Loan Program
    
In order to provide funding for students who are not able to fully finance the cost of their education under traditional governmental financial aid programs, commercial loan programs or other alternative sources, we established a private loan program with a bank.

Under the terms of the proprietary loan program, the bank originates loans for our students who meet our specific credit criteria with the related proceeds used exclusively to fund a portion of their tuition. We then purchase all such loans from the bank at least monthly and assume all of the related credit risk. The loans bear interest at market rates ranging from approximately 7% to 10%; however, principal and interest payments are not required until six months after the student completes or withdraws from his or her program. After the deferral period, monthly principal and interest payments are required over the related term of the loan. The repayment term is up to 10 years.

The bank provides these services in exchange for a fee at a percentage of the principal balance of each loan and related fees. Under the terms of the related agreement, we transfer funds for loan purchases to a deposit account with the bank in advance of the bank funding the loan, which secures our related loan purchase obligation. Such funds are classified as restricted cash in our consolidated balance sheet.
    
All related expenses incurred with the bank or other service providers are expensed as incurred within educational services and facilities expense and were approximately $0.9 million, $1.1 million and $1.3 million for the years ended September 30, 2020, 2019, and 2018, respectively.
    
The portion of tuition revenue related to the proprietary loan program is considered a form of variable consideration. We estimate the amount we ultimately expect to collect from the portion of tuition that is funded by the proprietary loan program, resulting in a note receivable. Estimating the collection rate requires significant management judgment. The estimated amount is determined at the inception of the contract, and we recognize the related revenue as the student progresses through school. Each reporting period, we update our assessment of the variable collection rate associated with the proprietary loan program.

Prior to adopting ASC 606 on October 1, 2017, we recognized revenue related to the proprietary loan program as cash was received.

Restricted Cash

Restricted cash includes funds held as collateral for certain of the surety bonds that our insurers issue on behalf of our campuses and admissions representatives with multiple states, which are required to maintain authorization to conduct our business, funds transferred in advance of loan purchases under our proprietary loan program and funds held for students from Title IV financial aid program funds that result in credit balances on a student’s account.

Allowance for Uncollectible Accounts

We maintain an allowance for uncollectible accounts for estimated losses resulting from the inability, failure or refusal of our students to make required payments. We offer a variety of payment plans to help students pay that portion of their education
F- 11

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
expenses not covered by financial aid programs or alternate fund sources, which are unsecured and not guaranteed. Management analyzes accounts receivable, historical percentages of uncollectible accounts, customer credit worthiness and changes in payment history when evaluating the adequacy of the allowance for uncollectible accounts. We use an internal group of collectors, augmented by third party collectors as deemed appropriate, in our collection efforts. Although we believe that our allowance is adequate, if the financial condition of our students deteriorates, resulting in an impairment of their ability to make payments, or if we underestimate the allowances required, additional allowances may be necessary, which would result in increased selling, general and administrative expenses in the period such determination is made.
Property and Equipment
Property, equipment and leasehold improvements are recorded at cost less accumulated depreciation and amortization. Depreciation and amortization expense are calculated using the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the related assets. Amortization of leasehold improvements is calculated using the straight-line method over the remaining useful life of the asset or term of lease, whichever is shorter. Costs relating to software developed for internal use and curriculum development are capitalized and amortized using the straight-line method over the related estimated useful lives. Such costs include direct costs of materials and services as well as payroll and related costs for employees who are directly associated with the projects. Maintenance and repairs are expensed as incurred.
We review the carrying value of our property and equipment for possible impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amounts may not be recoverable. We evaluate our long-lived assets for impairment by examining estimated future cash flows. These cash flows are evaluated by using probability weighting techniques as well as comparisons of past performance against projections. Assets may also be evaluated by identifying independent market values. If we determine that an asset’s carrying value is impaired, we will write-down the carrying value of the asset to its estimated fair value and charge the impairment as an operating expense in the period in which the determination is made. There were no significant impairment charges required for the years ended September 30, 2020, 2019 and 2018.
Goodwill
Our goodwill balance of $8.2 million resulted from the acquisition of our motorcycle and marine education business in 1998 and is allocated to our MMI Orlando, Florida campus that provides the related educational programs. Goodwill represents the excess of the cost of an acquired business over the estimated fair values of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed. Goodwill is reviewed at least annually for impairment, which may result from the deterioration in the operating performance of the acquired business, adverse market conditions, adverse changes in the applicable laws or regulations and a variety of other circumstances. Any resulting impairment charge would be recognized as an expense in the period in which impairment is identified.
On March 19, 2020, we suspended all in person classes at all of our campuses, including our Orlando, Florida campus, for the safety and protection of our students and staff, to help slow the spread of COVID-19, and to comply with state and local orders and restrictions. On March 25, 2020, we began offering the classroom portion of our training online so that students who elected to remain enrolled in the program could continue their education from home. During May of 2020, our Orlando, Florida campus reopened for students to complete hands-on labs, which have been re-designed to meet CDC, state and local guidelines for health, safety and social distancing. While some student graduation dates have been delayed due to the closure, the average students enrolled at our Orlando, Florida campus only decreased by 3.8% as compared to the prior year. Even with the impacts of COVID-19, our new student enrollments at the Orlando, Florida campus increased by 3.4% during 2020 over the prior year. After performing a qualitative analysis, there were no indicators of goodwill impairment as of September 30, 2020.
Self-Insurance Plans
We are self-insured for claims related to employee health and dental care and claims related to workers’ compensation. Liabilities associated with these plans are estimated by management with consideration of our historical loss experience, severity factors and independent actuarial analysis. Our claim liabilities are based on estimates, and while we believe the amounts accrued are adequate, the ultimate losses may differ from the amounts provided. Our recorded net liability related to self-insurance plans was $3.4 million as of September 30, 2020.
F- 12

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
Leases
We lease the majority of our administrative and educational facilities under operating lease agreements. Upon adoption of Accounting Standards Codification Topic 842, Leases (“ASC 842”) as of October 1, 2019, we derecognized our previously recorded deferred rent balance. ASC 842 requires lessees to recognize a right-of-use (“ROU”) asset and a lease liability on the balance sheet for substantially all leases, with the exception of short-term leases. Leases are classified as either finance or operating, with classification affecting the pattern of expense recognition in the statement of income. We adopted ASC 842 under a modified retrospective method without the recasting of comparative periods’ financial information. See Note 3 “Recent Accounting Pronouncements” for further detail regarding the adoption of ASC 842 and the impact on our financial statements and Note 10 “Leases” for our fiscal 2020 disclosures.
Advertising Costs
Costs related to advertising are expensed as incurred and totaled approximately $39.7 million, $41.2 million and $44.8 million for the years ended September 30, 2020, 2019, and 2018, respectively.
Stock-Based Compensation
Historically, we have issued restricted stock awards, restricted stock units and stock options. Restricted stock awards and restricted stock units are subject to vesting with service and performance conditions. We measure all share-based payments to employees at estimated fair value. We recognize the compensation expense for restricted stock awards and restricted stock units with only service conditions on a straight-line basis over the requisite service period. We granted restricted stock awards with both service and performance conditions during the year ended September 30, 2020. We did not grant any stock options during the year ended September 30, 2020. Shares issued under our equity compensation plans are new shares.
Compensation expense associated with restricted stock awards, restricted stock units and performance units is measured based on the grant date fair value of our common stock, discounted for non-participation in anticipated dividends during the vesting period. The requisite service period for restricted stock awards, restricted stock units and performance units is generally the vesting period.

We estimate the fair value of performance units using a Monte Carlo simulation which requires assumptions for expected volatility, risk-free rates of return, and dividend yields. Expected volatilities are derived using a method that calculates historical volatility over a period equal to the length of the measurement period for UTI. We use a risk-free rate of return that is equal to the yield of a zero-coupon U.S. Treasury bill that is commensurate with each measurement period, and we assume that any dividends paid were reinvested. 
Stock-based compensation expense of $2.1 million, $1.4 million and $1.9 million was recorded for the years ended September 30, 2020, 2019 and 2018, respectively. The tax benefit related to stock-based compensation recognized was $0.5 million, $0.4 million, and $0.5 million for the years ended September 30, 2020, 2019 and 2018, respectively. See Note 14 for further discussion.
Income Taxes
We recognize deferred tax assets and liabilities for the estimated future tax consequences of events attributable to differences between the financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases. We also recognize deferred tax assets for net operating loss and tax credit carryforwards. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using enacted tax rates in effect for the year in which the differences are expected to be recovered or settled. Deferred tax assets are reduced through a valuation allowance if it is more likely than not that the deferred tax assets will not be realized.
F- 13

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
Concentration of Risk
Financial instruments that potentially subject us to concentrations of credit risk consist principally of cash and cash equivalents, restricted cash, short-term investments and receivables. As of September 30, 2020, we held cash and cash equivalents of $76.8 million, restricted cash of $12.1 million and short-term held-to-maturity investments of $38.1 million.
We place our cash and cash equivalents and restricted cash with high quality financial institutions and limit the amount of credit exposure with any one financial institution. We mitigate the concentration risk of our investments by limiting the amount invested in any one issuer. We mitigate the risk associated with our investment in corporate bonds by requiring a minimum credit rating of A. We have the ability and intention to hold these investments until maturity and therefore have classified these investments as held-to-maturity and recorded them at amortized cost.
We extend credit for tuition and fees, for a limited period of time, to a majority of our students. A substantial portion is repaid through the student’s participation in federally funded financial aid programs. Transfers of funds from the financial aid programs to us are made in accordance with the ED requirements. Approximately 66% of our revenues, on a cash basis, were collected from funds distributed under Title IV Programs for the year ended September 30, 2020 as calculated under the 90/10 rule. Additionally, approximately 17% of our revenues, on a cash basis, were collected from funds distributed under various veterans benefits programs for the year ended September 30, 2020.
The financial aid and veterans benefits programs are subject to political and budgetary considerations. There is no assurance that such funding will be maintained at current levels. Extensive and complex regulations govern the financial assistance programs in which our students participate. Our administration of these programs is periodically reviewed by various regulatory agencies. Any regulatory violation could be the basis for the initiation of potential adverse actions, including a suspension, limitation, placement on reimbursement status or termination proceeding, which could have a material adverse effect on our business. ED and other regulators have increased the frequency and severity of their enforcement actions against postsecondary schools which have resulted in the imposition of material liabilities, sanctions, letter of credit requirements and other restrictions and, in some cases, resulted in the loss of schools’ eligibility to receive Title IV funds or in closure of the schools.
If any of our institutions were to lose its eligibility to participate in federal student financial aid programs, the students at that institution would lose access to funds derived from those programs and would have to seek alternative sources of funds to pay their tuition and fees. Students obtain access to federal student financial aid through an ED prescribed application and eligibility certification process. Student financial aid funds are generally made available to students at prescribed intervals throughout their predetermined expected length of study. Students typically apply the funds received from the federal financial aid programs to pay their tuition and fees. The transfer of funds is from the financial aid program to the student, who then uses those funds to pay for a portion of the cost of their education. The receipt of financial aid funds reduces the student’s amounts due to us and has no impact on revenue recognition, as the transfer relates to the source of funding for the costs of education, which may occur either through Title IV or other funds and resources available to the student.
Fair Value of Financial Instruments
The carrying value of cash equivalents, restricted cash, accounts receivable, accounts payable, accrued liabilities and deferred tuition approximates their respective fair value as of September 30, 2020 and 2019 due to the short-term nature of these instruments.
Start-up Costs
Costs related to the start-up of new campuses and programs are expensed as incurred.
F- 14

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
Note 3 - Recent Accounting Pronouncements
    
Accounting Pronouncements Effective in Fiscal 2020

Leases

In February 2016, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) issued ASU 2016-02, Leases (Topic 842) (“ASU 2016-02”), which amended the FASB Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) by creating ASC 842 to replace ASC 840. ASU 2016-02 requires lessees to recognize a right-of-use (“ROU”) asset and a lease liability on the balance sheet for substantially all leases, with the exception of short-term leases. Leases are classified as either finance or operating, with classification affecting the pattern of expense recognition in the statement of income. In July 2018, the FASB issued ASU 2018-11, Leases (Topic 842) to provide entities with relief from the costs of implementing certain aspects of the new leasing standard. It also allows lessors to elect not to separate lease and non-lease components when certain conditions are met. In March 2019, the FASB issued ASU 2019-01, Lease (Topic 842): Codification Improvements (“ASU 2019-01”). ASU 2019-01 clarifies certain items regarding lessor accounting. It also clarifies the interim disclosure requirements during transition.

The new guidance in ASC 842 also provides a package of transition practical expedients that allow an entity to not reassess (1) whether any expired or existing contracts contain a lease, (2) the lease classification of any expired or existing lease, and (3) initial direct costs for any existing lease. We adopted ASC 842 effective October 1, 2019, and elected the package of transition practical expedients. We also elected additional transitional practical expedients that allow an entity to not reassess land easements not previously addressed under ASC 840 and to not recognize on the balance sheet leases with terms of less than 12 months. We are using the modified retrospective method without the recasting of comparative periods’ financial information. We did not elect the practical expedient to use hindsight in determining a lease term of the ROU assets at the adoption date. As a result of adopting the new standard, we recognized an operating lease liability of $163.0 million and an operating lease ROU asset of $148.6 million on October 1, 2019. The change resulted in the de-recognition of approximately $0.9 million of other assets and $15.3 million of other liabilities. The standard did not materially impact our condensed consolidated statements of operations and cash flows.

In addition, we have two build-to-suit leases that were accounted for as financing obligations and related assets because we had continued involvement in the related facility after the construction period was completed. The financing obligations are now classified as operating leases in accordance with the new standard as of the transition date, including recognition of operating lease ROU assets and lease liabilities. The change resulted in the de-recognition of approximately $40.7 million existing deferred financing obligations and $31.6 million in related assets. The net impact of the de-recognition and the adoption of ASC 842 as of October 1, 2019 was an increase in stockholders’ equity of approximately $9.1 million, with a subsequent adjustment during the three months ended March 31, 2020, which reduced the impact to stockholders’ equity by $0.1 million. The transition also resulted in the recognition of rent expense, which was previously reported as interest expense under the former guidance. See Note 10 “Leases” for our fiscal 2020 disclosures.

Fair Value Measurement

In August 2018, the FASB issued ASU 2018-13, Fair Value Measurement (Topic 820) (“ASU 2018-13”). ASU 2018-13 amends the disclosure requirements of ASC 820, changing the fair value measurement disclosure requirements of ASC 820 by adding new disclosure requirements, modifying existing disclosure requirements and eliminating other disclosure requirements. We adopted ASU 2018-13 as of October 1, 2019. There was no impact to our consolidated financial statements or disclosures.

Cloud Computing Arrangements

In August 2018, the FASB issued ASU 2018-15, Intangibles—Goodwill and other Internal-use Software (Subtopic 350-40) (“ASU 2018-15”). ASU 2018-15 aligns the accounting for costs incurred to implement a cloud computing arrangement (“CCA”) that is a service arrangement with the guidance on capitalizing costs associated with developing or obtaining internal-use software. Specifically, ASU 2018-15 amends ASC 350 to include in its scope implementation costs of a CCA that is a service contract and clarifies that a customer should apply ASC 350-40 to determine which implementation costs
F- 15

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
should be capitalized in a CCA that is considered a service contract. The effect of this new standard on our consolidated financial statements is dependent on our entry into any future cloud computing arrangements.

Accounting Pronouncements Effective in Fiscal 2021

In June 2016, the FASB issued ASU 2016-13, Financial Instruments—Credit Losses: Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial Instruments (Topic 326). This update significantly changes the way that entities will be required to measure credit losses. This standard requires that entities estimate credit losses based upon an “expected credit loss” approach rather than the “incurred loss” approach, which is currently used. The new approach will require entities to measure all expected credit losses for financial assets based on historical experience, current conditions and reasonable forecasts of collectability. The change in approach is anticipated to impact the timing of recognition of credit losses. This standard is effective for financial statements issued by public companies for annual and interim periods beginning after December 15, 2019. These changes became effective for the Company's fiscal year beginning October 1, 2020. Upon adoption on October 1, 2020, we recorded an increase in our receivables balance related to our proprietary loan program of $1.6 million, with the corresponding amount recorded as an increase to retained earnings. No other adjustments were deemed necessary in applying this new guidance, and we do not expect the adoption of ASU 2016-13 to have a material impact on our results of operations.

Accounting Pronouncements Effective in Fiscal 2022

In December 2019, the FASB issued ASU 2019-12, Income Taxes (Topic 740): Simplifying the Accounting for Income Taxes (“ASU 2019-12”). The amendments in ASU 2019-12 simplify the accounting for income taxes by removing certain exceptions to the general principles in Topic 740. The amendments also improve consistent application of and simplify GAAP for other areas of Topic 740 by clarifying and amending existing guidance. We are currently evaluating the impact that the update will have on our results of operations, financial condition and financial statement disclosures.

Note 4 - Revenue from Contracts with Customers
Nature of Goods and Services
See Note 2 “Summary of Significant Accounting Policies” for a description of the nature of revenues.
Postsecondary Education
Revenues consist primarily of student tuition and fees derived from the programs we provide after reductions are made for discounts and scholarships that we sponsor and for refunds for students who withdraw from our programs prior to specified dates. We apply the five-step model outlined in ASC 606, Revenue from Contracts from Customers. Tuition and fee revenue is recognized ratably over the term of the course or program offered. The majority of our programs are designed to be completed in 36 to 90 weeks, and our advanced training programs range from 12 to 23 weeks in duration. We supplement our revenues with sales of textbooks and program supplies and other revenues, which are recognized as the transfer of goods or services occurs. Deferred revenue represents the excess of tuition and fee payments received as compared to tuition and fees earned and is reflected as a current liability in our condensed consolidated balance sheets because it is expected to be earned within the next 12 months.
Additionally, certain students participate in a proprietary loan program that extends repayment terms for their tuition.  We purchase said loans from the lender and, based on historical collection rates, believe a portion of these loans are collectible. Accordingly, we recognize tuition and loan origination fees financed by the loan and any related interest revenue under the effective interest method required under the loan based on the amount we expect to collect, and we recognize these revenues ratably over the term of the course or program offered.
Other
We provide dealer technician training or instructor staffing services to manufacturers. Revenues are recognized as transfer of the services occurs.
F- 16

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
We provide postsecondary education and other services in the same geographical market, the United States. The impact of economic factors on the nature, amount, timing and uncertainty of revenue and cash flows is consistent among our various postsecondary education programs. See Note 19 “Segment Information” for disaggregated segment revenue information.
Contract Balances
Contract assets primarily relate to our rights to consideration for a student’s progress through our training program in relation to our services performed but not billed at the reporting date. The contract assets are transferred to the receivables when the rights become unconditional. Currently, we do not have any contract assets that have not transferred to a receivable. Our deferred revenue is considered a contract liability and primarily relates to our enrollment agreements where we received payments for tuition but we have not yet delivered the related training programs to satisfy the related performance obligations. The advance consideration received from students or Title IV funding is deferred revenue until the training program has been delivered to the students.
The following table provides information about receivables and contract liabilities from contracts with customers:
September 30, 2020 September 30, 2019
Receivables, which includes Tuition and Notes Receivable $ 53,144  $ 44,629 
Deferred revenue $ 40,694  $ 42,886 

During the year ended September 30, 2020, the contract liabilities balance included decreases for revenues recognized during the period and increases related to new students who started school during the period.
Transaction Price Allocated to the Remaining Performance Obligations
Tuition and fee revenue is recognized ratably over the term of the course or program offered. The majority of our programs are designed to be completed in 36 to 90 weeks, and our advanced training programs range from 12 to 23 weeks in duration.
Impacts of COVID-19
On March 19, 2020, we suspended all in person classes at all of our campuses for the safety and protection of our students and staff, to help slow the spread of COVID-19 and to comply with state and local orders and restrictions. Upon the suspension of all in person classes, we provided all students with the opportunity to take a leave of absence or to continue their education via an online curriculum. We do not recognize revenue while a student is on a leave of absence. On March 25, 2020, we began offering the classroom portion of our training online so that the more than 8,000 students who elected to remain active in the program could continue their education remotely. As our training is a combination of classroom lectures and hands-on labs, there is a portion of most classes that cannot be delivered online and needs to be completed in-person at the campus lab.

During the year ended September 30, 2020, as campuses were able to reopen, we transitioned our on-campus, in-person education model to a blended training model that combines instructor-facilitated online teaching and demonstrations with hands-on labs. In May 2020, we resumed in-person labs at eight of our campus locations. Four of our campuses resumed in-person labs in June 2020, and our final campus resumed in-person labs in Bloomfield, New Jersey on July 1, 2020. On-campus labs have been re-designed to meet the health, safety and social distancing guidelines imposed by the Centers for Disease Control (“CDC”) and state and local jurisdictions, while still meeting our accreditation and curriculum requirements.

Upon the initial resumption of in-person labs, once a student returned to campus for in-person labs, under the new guidelines it takes on average approximately six to nine weeks for that student to catch up on the lab work that he was unable to complete during the campus closure and prior to his return. As of September 30, 2020, approximately 5% of students had not returned to campus to complete the in-person labs and remain only in the online portion of the curriculum, essentially only completing half of each course, while approximately 28% of students were completing catch up labs, but over an extended period of time. We continue to recognize revenue ratably over the term of the course or program offered, taking into consideration those only completing the online curriculum, and the catch-up period for active students and the impact it has on expected graduation dates. As a result, as of September 30, 2020, we had deferred revenue of $6.1 million.

F- 17

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
Note 5 - Post-employment Benefits

On February 18, 2019, we announced that our campus in Norwood, Massachusetts is no longer accepting new student applications, and its last group of students started on March 18, 2019 and completed the curriculum in July 2020, with the campus closing on July 31, 2020. The post-employment benefits incurred due to the campus closure were approximately $1.1 million.

Additionally, we periodically enter into agreements that provide post-employment benefits to personnel whose employment is terminated. On October 21, 2019, we announced the retirement of our former President and Chief Executive Officer, Kimberly J. McWaters, effective October 31, 2019. During the twelve months ended September 30, 2020, we incurred post-employment benefit charges of $1.5 million and paid cash of $1.2 million, in accordance with Ms. McWaters’ Retirement Agreement and Release of Claims, dated October 31, 2019.

The post-employment benefit liability, which is included in “Accounts payable and accrued expenses” on the accompanying consolidated balance sheets, is generally paid out ratably over the terms of the agreements, which range from 1 month to 24 months, with the final agreement expiring in 2021.

The post-employment benefit accrual activity for the years ended September 30, 2020 and 2019 was as follows:
Severance Other Total
Balance accrued as of September 30, 2018 $ 372  $ $ 381 
Post-employment benefit charges 1,637  90  1,727 
Cash paid (1,159) (28) (1,187)
Other non-cash adjustments(1)
(129) (39) (168)
Balance accrued as of September 30, 2019 $ 721  $ 32  $ 753 
   Post-employment benefit charges 2,223  57  2,280 
   Cash paid (2,210) (51) (2,261)
   Other non-cash adjustments(1)
131  (29) 102 
Balance accrued as of September 30, 2020 $ 865  $ $ 874 
(1) Primarily relates to the reclassification of benefits between severance and other benefits.

Note 6 - Receivables, net
Receivables, net consist of the following:
  September 30,
2020 2019
Tuition receivables $ 23,565  $ 11,800 
Tax receivables(1)
7,145  156 
Other receivables 6,494  7,078 
Receivables 37,204  19,034 
Less: allowance for uncollectible accounts (1,793) (1,097)
Receivables, net $ 35,411  $ 17,937 
(1) Primarily related to an income tax receivable recorded as a result of the net operation loss provisions in the CARES Act. See Note 13 “Income Taxes” for further discussion.
The allowance for uncollectible accounts is estimated using our historical write-off experience applied to the receivable balances for students who are no longer attending school due to graduation or withdrawal or who are in school and have
F- 18

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
receivable balances in excess of financial aid available to them. We write off receivable balances against the allowance for uncollectible accounts at the time we transfer the balance to a third party collection agency.
 
The following table summarizes the activity for our allowance for uncollectible accounts for the years ended September 30, 2020, 2019 and 2018:
Year Ended September 30,
2020 2019 2018
Balance at beginning of period $ 1,097  $ 999  $ 579 
Additions to bad debt expense 1,767  1,166  1,511 
Write-offs of uncollectible accounts (1,071) (1,068) (1,091)
Balance at end of period $ 1,793  $ 1,097  $ 999 

Note 7 - Investments

In February 2020, we raised approximately $49.5 million in net proceeds from an underwritten public offering of shares of our common stock. See Note 15 “Shareholders’ Equity” for further details on the equity offering. We invested a portion of the proceeds from the equity offering in held-to-maturity securities, which primarily consist of corporate bonds from large cap industrial and selected financial companies with a minimum credit rating of A. We have the ability and intention to hold these investments until maturity and therefore have classified these investments as held-to-maturity and recorded them at amortized cost.

The amortized cost, gross unrealized gains or losses, and fair value of investments classified as held-to-maturity at September 30, 2020 were as follows:
Gross Unrealized Estimated Fair
Due in less than 1 year: Amortized Cost Gains Losses Market Value
Corporate and municipal bonds $ 38,055  $ 10  $ (33) $ 38,032 
Total as of September 30, 2020 $ 38,055  $ 10  $ (33) $ 38,032 

Investments are exposed to various risks, including interest rate, market and credit risk. As a result, it is possible that changes in the values of these investments may occur and that such changes could affect the amounts reported in the condensed consolidated financial statements.
Note 8 - Fair Value Measurements
The accounting framework for determining fair value includes a hierarchy for ranking the quality and reliability of the information used to measure fair value, which enables the reader of the financial statements to assess the inputs used to develop those measurements. The fair value hierarchy consists of three tiers:
Level 1:    Defined as quoted market prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities.
Level 2:    Defined as inputs other than Level 1 that are observable, either directly or indirectly, such as quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities, quoted prices in markets that are not active, model-based valuation techniques for which all significant assumptions are observable in the market or other inputs that are observable or can be corroborated by observable market data for substantially the full term of the assets or liabilities.
Level 3:    Defined as unobservable inputs that are not corroborated by market data.
Any transfers of investments between levels occurs at the end of the reporting period. Assets measured or disclosed at fair value on a recurring basis consisted of the following:
F- 19

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
    Fair Value Measurements Using
  September 30, 2020 Quoted Prices
in Active
Markets for
Identical Assets
(Level 1)
Significant
Other
Observable
Inputs
(Level 2)
Significant
Unobservable
Inputs
(Level 3)
Money market funds(1)
$ 43,322  $ 43,322  $ —  $ — 
Notes receivable(2)
32,793  —  —  32,793 
Corporate bonds(3)
33,119  33,119  —  — 
Municipal bonds, and other(3)
4,913  4,913  —  — 
Total assets at fair value on a recurring basis $ 114,147  $ 81,354  $ —  $ 32,793 

    Fair Value Measurements Using
  September 30, 2019 Quoted Prices
in Active
Markets for
Identical Assets
(Level 1)
Significant
Other
Observable
Inputs
(Level 2)
Significant
Unobservable
Inputs
(Level 3)
Money market funds(1)
$ 37,794  $ 37,794  $ —  $ — 
Notes receivable(2)
35,079  —  —  35,079 
Total assets at fair value on a recurring basis $ 72,873  $ 37,794  $ —  $ 35,079 

(1) Money market funds and other highly liquid investments with maturity dates less than 90 days are reflected as “Cash and cash equivalents” in our consolidated balance sheet as of September 30, 2020 and 2019.
(2) Notes receivable relate to our proprietary loan program.
(3) Corporate bonds, municipal bonds, and other are reflected as “Held-to-maturity investments” in our consolidated balance sheet as of September 30, 2020.

Note 9 - Property and Equipment, net
Property and equipment, net consisted of the following:
Depreciable
Lives (in years)
September 30,
2020
September 30,
2019
Land $ 3,189  $ 3,189 
Building and building improvements
3-35
28,046  82,653 
Leasehold improvements
1-28
62,899  53,020 
Training equipment
3-10
91,731  96,737 
Office and computer equipment
3-10
33,524  35,927 
Curriculum development 5 19,692  19,692 
Software developed for internal use
1-5
11,951  11,354 
Vehicles 5 1,502  1,454 
Right-of-use assets for finance leases
2-3
359  — 
Construction in progress 2,213  1,631 
255,106  305,657 
Less: accumulated depreciation and amortization (182,363) (201,531)
Property and equipment, net $ 72,743  $ 104,126 
As previously discussed in Note 3 “Summary of Significant Accounting Policies,” the adoption of ASC 842 as of October 1, 2019 resulted in the de-recognition of the assets associated with our financing obligations, which were previously included in
F- 20

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
“Buildings and building improvements.” In addition, certain items related to the build-to-suit leases in “Buildings and building improvements” were reclassified to “Leasehold improvements” as part of the adoption of ASC 842.
The following amounts, which are included in the above table, represented assets financed by financing obligations as of September 30, 2019:
September 30,
2019
Assets financed by financing obligations, gross $ 45,816 
Less: accumulated depreciation and amortization (14,208)
Assets financed by financing obligations, net $ 31,608 

Note 10 - Leases

We lease 10 of our 12 campuses and our corporate headquarters under non-cancelable operating leases, some of which contain escalation clauses and requirements to pay other fees associated with the leases. Our lease for the Norwood, Massachusetts campus ended on July 31, 2020 when the campus closed. During the year ended September 30, 2020, we relocated our corporate headquarters facility in conjunction with the expiration of the existing lease agreement, and entered into a new long-term lease agreement at a new facility. We also modified our existing lease for our Sacramento campus by extending the term, and reducing the leased square footage effective as of January 1, 2022. Our facility leases have original lease terms ranging from 8 to 20 years and expire at various dates through 2033. In addition, the leases commonly include lease incentives in the form of rent abatements and tenant improvement allowances. We sublease certain portions of unused building space to third parties, which currently result in minimal income. All of the leases, other than those that may qualify for the short-term scope exception of 12 months or less, are recorded on our consolidated balance sheets.

Some of the facility leases are subject to annual changes in the Consumer Price Index (“CPI”). While lease liabilities are not remeasured as a result of changes to the CPI, changes to the CPI are treated as variable lease payments and recognized in the period in which the obligation for those payments was incurred. Many of our lease agreements include options to extend the lease, which we do not include in our minimum lease terms unless they are reasonably certain to be exercised. There are no early termination with penalties, residual value guarantees, restrictions or covenants imposed by our facility leases.

Significant Assumptions and Judgments

To determine if a contract is or contains a lease, we considered whether (1) explicitly or implicitly identified assets have been deployed in the contract and (2) we obtain substantially all of the economic benefits from the use of that underlying asset and direct how and for what purpose the asset is used during the term of the contract. If we determine a contract is, or contains, a lease, we assess whether the contract contains multiple lease components. We consider a lease component to be separate from other lease components in the contract if (a) we can benefit from the right of use either on its own or together with other resources that are readily available to us and (b) the right of use is neither highly dependent on nor highly interrelated with the other right(s) to use underlying assets in the contract. In contracts involving the use of real estate, we separate the right to use land from other underlying assets unless the effect of separating the land is insignificant to the resulting lease accounting. We have elected to account for the lease and non-lease components as a single lease component.

For all leases we are a party to, the discount rate implicit in the lease was not readily determinable. Therefore, we used our incremental borrowing rate for each lease to determine the present value of the lease. We determined the incremental borrowing rate applicable to each lease through a model that represents the rate of interest we would have to pay to borrow on a collateralized basis over a similar term an amount equal to the lease payments in a similar economic environment. The incremental borrowing rate was applied to each lease based on the remaining term of the lease.

The components of lease expense are included in “Educational services and facilities” and “Selling, general and administrative” on the consolidated statement of operations, with the exception of interest on lease liabilities, which is included in “Interest expense.”
F- 21

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)

The components of lease expense during the year ended September 30, 2020 were as follows:
Lease Expense Year ended September 30, 2020
Operating lease expense(1)
$ 29,348 
Finance lease expense:
   Amortization of leased assets 102 
   Interest on lease liabilities
Variable lease expense 4,120 
Sublease income (744)
Total net lease expense $ 32,833 

(1) Excludes the expense for short-term leases not accounted for under ASC 842, which was not significant for the year ended September 30, 2020.

Supplemental balance sheet, cash flow and other information related to our leases was as follows:
Leases Classification As of September 30, 2020
Assets:
Operating lease assets Right-of-use assets for operating leases $ 144,663 
Finance lease assets
Property and equipment, net(1)
257 
Total leased assets $ 144,920 
Liabilities:
Current
   Operating lease liabilities Operating lease liability, current portion $ 23,666 
   Finance lease liabilities Other current liabilities 129 
Noncurrent
   Operating lease liabilities Operating lease liability 134,089 
   Finance lease liabilities Other liabilities 131 
Total lease liabilities $ 158,015 

(1) Finance lease assets are recorded net of accumulated amortization of $0.1 million as of September 30, 2020.

F- 22

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
Supplemental Disclosure of Cash Flow Information and Other Information Year ended September 30, 2020
Cash paid for amounts included in the measurement of lease liabilities:
   Operating cash flows from operating leases $ 25,617 
   Operating cash flows from finance leases
   Financing cash flows from finance leases 99 
Non-cash activity related to lease liabilities:
   Lease assets obtained in exchange for new operating lease liabilities $ 20,321 
   Leases assets obtained in exchange for new finance lease liabilities 215 

Lease Term and Discount Rate As of September 30, 2020
Weighted-average remaining lease term (in years):
   Operating leases 9.34
   Finance leases 2.05
Weighted average discount rate:
   Operating leases 4.37  %
   Finance leases 3.08  %

Maturities of lease liabilities were as follows:
As of September 30, 2020
Years ending September 30, Operating Leases Finance Leases
2021 $ 28,212  $ 135 
2022 27,447  110 
2023 18,565  23 
2024 17,435  — 
2025 15,022  — 
2026 and thereafter 86,134  — 
Total lease payments 192,815  268 
Less: interest (35,060) (8)
Present value of lease liabilities 157,755  260 
Less: current lease liabilities (23,666) (129)
Long-term lease liabilities $ 134,089  $ 131 

The maturities of lease liabilities as of September 30, 2020 includes the future minimum lease payments for the build-to-suit leases.

Disclosures Related to Periods Prior to the Adoption of ASC 842

As of September 30, 2019, minimum lease payments under non-cancelable operating leases by period were expected to be as follows (in thousands):
F- 23

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
Years ending September 30, Gross Sublease income Net
2020 $ 26,379  $ (362) $ 26,017 
2021 23,531  (77) 23,454 
2022 21,621  (78) 21,543 
2023 10,461  (20) 10,441 
2024 9,180  —  9,180 
Thereafter 41,822  —  41,822 
Total lease payments $ 132,994  $ (537) $ 132,457 

Related Party Transactions for Leases

Rent expense includes rent paid to related parties, which was approximately $2.0 million for the years ended September 30, 2020, 2019, and 2018. Since 1991, two of our properties comprising our Orlando, Florida location have been leased from entities controlled by John C. White, a director on our Board of Directors. The leases extend through August 19, 2022 and August 31, 2022 with annual base lease payments for the first year under this lease totaling approximately $0.3 million and $0.7 million, with annual adjustments based on the higher of (i) an amount equal to 4% of the total annual rent for the immediately preceding year or (ii) the percentage of increase in the CPI. These transactions were not considered significant as of September 30, 2020.

Note 11 - Investment in Unconsolidated Affiliate

In 2012, we invested $4.0 million to acquire an equity interest of approximately 28% in a joint venture (JV) related to the lease of our Lisle, Illinois campus facility. In connection with this investment, we do not possess a controlling financial interest as we do not hold a majority of the equity interest, nor do we have the power to make major decisions without approval from the other equity member. Therefore, we do not qualify as the primary beneficiary. Accordingly, this investment is accounted for under the equity method of accounting and is included in other assets in our consolidated balance sheet. We recognize our proportionate share of the JV’s net income or loss during each accounting period as a change in our investment.

Historically, the JV used an interest rate cap to manage interest rate risk associated with its floating rate debt.  This derivative instrument was designated as a cash flow hedge based on the nature of the risk being hedged.  As such, the effective portion of the gain or loss on the derivative was initially reported as a component of the JV’s accumulated other comprehensive income or loss, net of tax, and was subsequently reclassified into earnings when the hedged transaction affects earnings.  Any ineffective portion of the gain or loss was recognized in the JV’s current earnings.  Due to our equity method investment in the JV, when the JV reports a current year component of other comprehensive income (OCI), we, as an investor, likewise adjust our investment account for the change in investee equity.  In addition, we adjust our OCI for our share of the JV’s currently reported OCI item. During the three months ended December 31, 2017, the JV refinanced the facility loan and discontinued its use of an interest rate cap.

Our equity in earnings of unconsolidated affiliates was $0.4 million for the years ended September 30, 2020, 2019 and 2018.

Investment in our unconsolidated affiliate consists of the following:
September 30, 2020 September 30, 2019
Carrying Value Ownership Percentage Carrying Value Ownership Percentage
Investment in JV $ 4,494  28.0  % $ 4,338  28.0  %
F- 24

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)

Investment in our unconsolidated affiliate included the following activity during the period:
Year ended September 30,
2020 2019
Balance at beginning of period $ 4,338  $ 4,206 
Equity in earnings of unconsolidated affiliate 417  399 
Return of capital contribution from unconsolidated affiliate (261) (267)
Balance at end of period $ 4,494  $ 4,338 

Through September 30, 2019, the activity from equity in earnings of the unconsolidated affiliate was included in “Other (expense) income, net” on the condensed consolidated statements of operations. In conjunction with the adoption of ASC 842, as previously described in Note 3 “Summary of Significant Accounting Policies,” beginning October 1, 2019, the activity is included in “Educational services and facilities” on the consolidated statements of operations.

Note 12 - Accounts Payable and Accrued Expenses
Accounts payable and accrued expenses consisted of the following:
September 30,
2020 2019
Accounts payable $ 12,471  $ 10,033 
Accrued compensation and benefits 28,053  22,230 
Other accrued expenses 11,367  13,615 
Accounts payable and accrued expenses $ 51,891  $ 45,878 

Note 13 - Income Taxes

The components of income tax benefit (expense) for the years ended September 30, 2020, 2019 and 2018 are as follows:
  Year Ended September 30,
2020 2019 2018
Current benefit (expense):
United States federal $ 11,250  $ $ 125 
State (303) (205) 78 
Total current benefit (expense) 10,947  (203) 203 
Deferred benefit (expense):
United States federal (345) —  2,878 
State —  —  (66)
Total deferred benefit (expense) (345) —  2,812 
Total income tax benefit (expense) $ 10,602  $ (203) $ 3,015 

F- 25

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
The income tax provision differs from the tax that would result from application of the statutory federal tax rate of 21.0% to pre-tax income for the years ended September 30, 2020 and September 30, 2019, and 24.5% to pre-tax income for the year ended September 30, 2018. The reasons for the differences are as follows:
  Year Ended September 30,
2020 2019 2018
Income tax benefit at statutory rate $ 545  $ 1,610  $ 8,746 
State income taxes, net of federal tax benefit (246) (165) 12 
Change in federal statutory rate —  —  (12,645)
Decrease (increase) in valuation allowance 6,135  (1,514) 7,066 
Net operating losses carryback to higher federal statutory rate years 4,270  —  — 
Other, net (102) (134) (164)
Total income tax benefit (expense) $ 10,602  $ (203) $ 3,015 

The components of the deferred tax assets (liabilities) recorded in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets were as follows:
  September 30,
2020 2019
Gross deferred tax assets:
Right-of-use assets for operating leases $ 40,515  $ — 
Deferred compensation $ 802  $ 1,449 
Accrued compensation 3,940  2,432 
Accrued tool sets 831  694 
Other reserves and accruals 2,665  1,884 
Deferred revenue 4,406  4,324 
Deferred rent liability —  3,024 
Financing obligation —  10,178 
Net operating losses 6,729  12,639 
Tax credit carryforwards 293  205 
Charitable contribution carryovers 1,527  1,234 
Deductions limited by Section 382 764  670 
Valuation allowance (17,449) (25,673)
Total gross deferred tax assets 45,023  13,060 
Gross deferred tax liabilities:
Operating lease liability (37,083) — 
Amortization of goodwill and intangibles (2,056) (2,056)
Depreciation and amortization of property and equipment (5,547) (10,470)
Prepaid and other expenses deductible for tax (1,011) (863)
Total gross deferred tax liabilities (45,697) (13,389)
Net deferred tax liabilities $ (674) $ (329)
    
F- 26

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
The following table summarizes the activity for the valuation allowance for the years ended September 30 2020, 2019 and 2018:

Year Ended September 30,
2020 2019 2018
Balance at beginning of period $ 25,673  $ 23,112  $ 38,407 
Additions (reductions) to income tax (5,947) 2,561  (5,555)
Write-offs(1)
(2,277) —  (9,740)
Balance at end of period $ 17,449  $ 25,673  $ 23,112 

(1) Of this total, approximately $9.6 million and $2.3 million related to our adoption of ASC 606 as of October 1, 2017 and our adoption of ASC 842 as of October 1, 2019, respectively.

We have valuation allowances of $17.4 million and $25.7 million against the deferred tax assets as of September 30, 2020 and September 30, 2019, respectively, based on our assessment of the ability to utilize the deferred tax assets. The valuation allowances established relate to all federal and state deferred tax assets, for which we determined that it was more likely than not that a benefit will not be realized. In assessing whether a valuation allowance was required for the deferred tax assets, we considered all available positive and negative evidence. A significant piece of negative evidence was the cumulative losses incurred in recent years.

The CARES Act, which was enacted on March 27, 2020, made tax law changes to provide financial relief to companies as a result of the business impacts of COVID-19. Key income tax provisions of the CARES Act include changes in net operating loss (“NOL”) carryback and carryforwards rules, acceleration of alternative minimum tax credit recovery, increase of the net interest expense deduction limit and charitable contribution limit, and immediate write-off of qualified improvement property. The CARES Act allows us to carryback $20.3 million and $13.0 million of NOLs arising in the years ended September 30, 2019 and September 30, 2018, respectively, generating a tax refund of approximately $11.3 million. During the three months ended March 31, 2020, we recorded a receivable for the expected refund. Approximately $4.2 million was received during the year ended September 30, 2020, leaving approximately $7.1 million in the receivable balance as of September 30, 2020.

As of September 30, 2020, we had approximately $18.9 million and $48.4 million in net operating losses for federal and state tax purposes, respectively. Approximately $2.3 million of the federal net operating losses expire in the year 2039 if not utilized, while the rest can be carryforward indefinitely. The state net operating losses expire in the years 2027 through 2040 if not utilized.

The calculation of our tax liabilities involves dealing with uncertainties in the application of complex tax laws and regulations. ASC 740 states that a tax benefit from an uncertain tax position may be recognized when it is more likely than not that the position will be sustained upon examination, including resolutions of any related appeals or litigation processes, on the basis of the technical merits. We believe that all of our tax positions meet the more-likely-than not test and therefore no uncertain tax positions were recorded as of September 30, 2020.

We file income tax returns for federal purposes and in many states. Our tax filings remain subject to examination by applicable tax authorities for certain length of time, generally three to four years, following the tax year to which these filings relate. In fiscal 2018, 2019 and 2020, we filed returns to carry back federal and certain state net operating losses to prior years. The statute of limitations for adjustment of the net operating losses utilized on these tax returns remains open an additional three to four years, depending on jurisdiction, from the date these returns were filed.

F- 27

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
Note 14 - Commitments and Contingencies
Licensing Agreements
In fiscal 1999, we entered into a licensing agreement that gives us the right to use certain materials and trademarks in the development of our courses. The agreement was amended in November 2009. Under the terms of the amended agreement, we are required to pay a flat fee per student for each program a student completes. There are no minimum license fees required to be paid. The agreement terminates upon the written notice of either party providing not less than ninety days notification of intent to terminate. License fees related to this agreement were $0.5 million, $0.6 million and $0.7 million for the years ended September 30, 2020, 2019 and 2018, respectively, and were recorded in educational services and facilities expenses.
In May 2007, we entered into a licensing agreement that gives us the right to use certain trademarks, trade names, trade dress and other intellectual property in connection with the operation of our campuses and courses. The agreement was amended January 2019 and expires December 31, 2026. We are committed to pay royalties based upon minimum amounts specified in the agreement, throughout the term. The agreement required a minimum royalty payment of $1.0 million in calendar year 2020. The expense related to these agreements was $1.2 million, $1.4 million and $1.6 million for the years ended September 30, 2020, 2019 and 2018, respectively, and was recorded in educational services and facilities expenses. Annual payments range between $1.0 million and $1.5 million throughout the licensing period.

In July 2013, we entered into a training and materials agreement that gives us the right to use certain materials and trademarks in development of our courses. Under the terms of the agreement, we are required to pay a flat fee per student for each related program a student completes. There is an immaterial minimum annual fee required to be paid upon commencement of the program and annually thereafter. The agreement terminates upon the written notice of either party providing not less than 90 days notification of intent to terminate. The expense related to this agreement was $0.1 million for the years ended September 30, 2020, 2019 and 2018, respectively, and was recorded in educational services and facilities expenses.

In April 2015, we entered into a licensing agreement that gives us the right to use certain trademarks in connection with the operation of our campuses and courses. The agreement has an initial term of four years, with options for three annual renewals totaling a seven year term. The maximum license fee over seven years is $2.3 million. The expense related to this agreement was $0.3 million, $0.2 million and $0.4 million for the years ended September 30, 2020, 2019 and 2018, respectively, and was recorded in educational services and facilities expenses.
Vendor Relationships
We have an agreement with a vendor that allows us to purchase promotional tool kits for our students at a discount from the vendor’s list price. In addition, we earn credits that are redeemable for equipment from the vendor that we use in our business. Credits are earned on our purchases as well as purchases made by students enrolled in our programs. We have agreed to grant the vendor exclusive access to our campuses, to display advertising and to use their tools to train our students. The credits under this agreement may be redeemed in multiple ways, which historically has been for additional equipment at the full retail list price, which is more than we would be required to pay using cash. The renewal was executed in October 2017 and expires October 31, 2022. The renewal allows us to redeem our credits for a portion of the tool sets we purchase for our students. Any product credits remaining at termination will expire 60 days after the date of termination. A net prepaid expense with the vendor resulted from an excess of credits earned over credits used of $5.5 million and $6.4 million as of September 30, 2020 and 2019, respectively, included in other current assets in our consolidated balance sheets.
Students are provided a Career Starter Tool Set Voucher which can be redeemed for a tool set near graduation. The cost of the tool sets, net of the credit, is accrued during the time period in which the students begin attending school until they have progressed to the point that the promotional tool set vouchers are provided. Our consolidated balance sheets include an accrued tool set liability of $3.1 million and $2.6 million as of September 30, 2020 and 2019, respectively. Additionally, our liability to the vendor for vouchers redeemed by students was $1.9 million and $2.1 million as of September 30, 2020 and 2019, respectively, and is included in accounts payable and accrued expenses in our consolidated balance sheets.
F- 28

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
Deferred Compensation Plans
We have established a deferred compensation plan (“the Plan”) effective April 1, 2010, into which certain members of management are eligible to defer a maximum of 75% of their regular compensation and a maximum of 100% of their incentive compensation. Non-employee members of our Board of Directors are eligible to defer up to 100% of their cash compensation. The amounts deferred by the participant under this Plan are credited with earnings or losses based upon changes in values of participant elected notional investments. Each participant is fully vested in the amounts deferred.
We may make contributions at the discretion of our Board of Directors that will generally vest according to a five year vesting schedule. Distribution elections under the Plan may be for separation from service distribution or in-service distribution. We are not obligated to fund the Plan; however, we have purchased life insurance policies on the participants in order to fund the related benefits and such policies have been placed into a rabbi trust.
Our obligations under the Plan totaled $3.0 million and $4.3 million as of September 30, 2020 and 2019, respectively, and are included in other liabilities while the cash surrender value of the life insurance policies totaled $3.3 million and $4.8 million as of September 30, 2020 and 2019, respectively, and are included in other assets in our consolidated balance sheets.
Surety Bonds
Each of our campuses must be authorized by the applicable state education agency in which the campus is located to operate and to grant certificates, diplomas or degrees to its students. Our campuses are subject to extensive, ongoing regulation by each of these states. Additionally, our campuses are required to be authorized by the applicable state education agencies of certain other states in which our campuses recruit students. Our insurers issue surety bonds for us on behalf of our campuses and admissions representatives with multiple states to maintain authorization to conduct our business. We are obligated to reimburse our insurers for any surety bonds that are paid by the insurers. As of September 30, 2020, the total face amount of these surety bonds was approximately $16.8 million.
Legal
In the ordinary conduct of our business, we are periodically subject to lawsuits, demands in arbitration, investigations, regulatory proceedings or other claims, including, but not limited to, claims involving current or former students, routine employment matters, business disputes and regulatory demands. When we are aware of a claim or potential claim, we assess the likelihood of any loss or exposure. If it is probable that a loss will result and the amount of the loss can be reasonably estimated, we would accrue a liability for the loss. When a loss is not both probable and estimable, we do not accrue a liability. Where a loss is not probable but is reasonably possible, including if a loss in excess of an accrued liability is reasonably possible, we determine whether it is possible to provide an estimate of the amount of the loss or range of possible losses for the claim. Because we cannot predict with certainty the ultimate resolution of the legal proceedings (including lawsuits, investigations, regulatory proceedings or claims) asserted against us, it is not currently possible to provide such an estimate. The ultimate outcome of pending legal proceedings to which we are a party may have a material adverse effect on our business, cash flows, results of operations or financial condition.

Note 15 - Shareholders’ Equity

Common Stock

Holders of our common stock are entitled to receive dividends when and as declared by our Board of Directors and have the right to one vote per share on all matters requiring shareholder approval. On June 9, 2016, our Board of Directors voted to eliminate the quarterly cash dividend on our common stock.

Preferred Stock

Preferred Stock consists of 10,000,000 authorized preferred shares of $0.0001 par value each. As of September 30, 2020 and 2019, 700,000 shares of Series A Preferred Stock were issued and outstanding.
F- 29

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)

On June 24, 2016, we entered into a Securities Purchase Agreement (“Purchase Agreement”) with Coliseum Holdings I, LLC (“Purchaser”) to sell to the Purchaser 700,000 shares of Series A Preferred Stock for a total purchase price of $70.0 million. The proceeds from the offering were used to fund strategic initiatives to drive growth including; the transformation plan, expansion to new markets with metro campuses and the creation of new programs in existing markets with under-utilized campus facilities. The Series A Preferred Stock is perpetual, and therefore does not have a maturity date. In conjunction with this purchase, we incurred $1.2 million in stock issuance costs, which were recorded as a reduction of the additional paid-in capital associated with the Series A Preferred Stock.

The description below provides a summary of certain material terms of the Series A Preferred Stock as set forth in the Certificate of Designations (“Certificate of Designations”) of the Series A Preferred Stock:

Rank

The Series A Preferred Stock will, with respect to dividend rights and rights upon liquidation, winding up or dissolution, rank senior to our common stock and each other junior class or series of shares that we may issue in the future. The Series A Preferred Stock will also rank junior to any future indebtedness.

Dividends

We may pay a cash dividend on each share of the Series A Preferred Stock at a rate of 7.5% per year on the liquidation preference then in effect (“Cash Dividend”). The Cash Dividend is payable before any dividends would be declared or paid to common stockholders or other junior stockholders. If we do not pay a Cash Dividend, the liquidation preference shall be increased to an amount equal to the current liquidation preference in effect plus an amount reflecting that liquidation preference multiplied by the Cash Dividend rate then in effect plus 2.0% per year (“Accrued Dividend”). Cash Dividends are payable semi-annually in arrears on September 30 and March 31 of each year, and will begin to accrue on the first day of the applicable dividend period. We paid Cash Dividends of $5.3 million during the years ended September 30, 2020 and September 30, 2019.

The Series A Preferred Stock includes participation rights such that, in the event that we pay a dividend or make a distribution on the outstanding common stock, we shall also pay to each holder of the Series A Preferred Stock a dividend on an as converted basis.

If we are required to or elect to obtain stockholder and regulatory approval and if such approval is not obtained within the time periods set forth in the Certificate, the dividend rates with respect to the Cash Dividend and Accrued Dividend will be increased by 5.0% per year, not to exceed a maximum of 14.5% per year, subject to downward adjustment on obtaining the foregoing approvals.

Liquidation Preference    

In the event of voluntary or involuntary liquidation, dissolution or winding up of our company, holders of the Series A Preferred Stock are entitled to receive, before any distribution or payment to the holders of any common or junior stock, an amount per share of Series A Preferred Stock equal to the liquidation preference then in effect, which would include any Accrued Dividends. Alternatively, the holder may choose to receive the amount that would be payable per share of common stock issued upon conversion of the Series A Preferred Stock immediately prior to such liquidation event.

Mergers (regardless of whether we remain the surviving entity), sale of substantially all of our assets or any other recapitalization, reclassification or other transaction in which substantially all of our common stock is exchanged or converted into cash or other property are considered “Deemed Liquidation Events.” The Certificate of Designations provides that, in the case of a Deemed Liquidation Event, each holder of Series A Preferred Stock shall be entitled to receive the liquidation amount they would receive under a normal liquidation event; however, the liquidation amount must be in the same form of consideration as is payable to the holders of our common stock.

The liquidation preference associated with the Series A Preferred Stock was $100 per share at September 30, 2020 and 2019.
F- 30

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)

Voting

Holders of Series A Preferred Stock are entitled to vote with the holders of shares of common stock on an as converted basis, subject to the Continuing Caps as discussed below.

A majority of the voting power of the Series A Preferred Stock must approve certain significant actions, including, without limitation, the issuance of certain equity securities; the repurchase, redemption or acquisition of our common stock; the incurrence of debt; the consummation of certain acquisitions, mergers or other such transactions; and the sale of material assets.

The Certificate of Designations includes a Conversion Cap and an Investor Voting Cap (each as defined in the Certificate of Designations), which generally prohibit: (i) the conversion of Series A Preferred Stock into common stock; and (ii) the voting of common stock issuable upon conversion of the Series A Preferred Stock, to the extent that such conversion results in the issuance of a number of shares of common stock exceeding 4.99% of our outstanding shares of common stock as of June 24, 2016 or that has voting power that exceeds 4.99% of the voting power of our outstanding shares of common stock as of June 24, 2016.

The Certificate of Designations provides that the Conversion Cap and the Investor Voting Cap may only be removed upon our receipt of: (i) certain stockholder approvals required by Section 312.03 of the New York Stock Exchange Listed Company Manual (“NYSE Rule 312”); and (ii) either (A) Education Regulatory Approval (as defined in the Certificate of Designations), or (B) a good faith determination by our board of directors that Education Regulatory Approval is not required. Our stockholders approved a proposal at the annual meeting of stockholders on February 27, 2020, in accordance with the listing standards of the NYSE, that satisfied NYSE Rule 312.

In August 2020, the Purchaser notified us that it intended to distribute all 700,000 Series A Preferred Stock to its members, and that certain of its members would subsequently distribute their Series A Preferred Stock to (i) limited partners affiliated with the Purchaser and certain other entities for whom Coliseum Capital Management, LLC (an affiliate of the Purchaser) holds voting and dispositive power with respect to the Series A Preferred Stock (the “Affiliated Holders”), which six Affiliated Holders, following such distribution, will own Series A Preferred Stock that would represent, on an as converted basis, approximately 24.9% of our outstanding shares of common stock and voting power, and (ii) limited partners unaffiliated with the Purchaser (the “Unaffiliated Holders”), which 12 Unaffiliated Holders, following such distribution, each will own Series A Preferred Stock that would represent, on an as converted basis, 9.9% or less of our outstanding shares of common stock and voting power (collectively, the “Distributions”).

In connection with the Distributions, our board of directors, based on advice of legal counsel, determined that: (i) no Education Regulatory Approval would be required for the Unaffiliated Holders to remove the Conversion Cap and the Investor Voting Cap with respect to the Series A Preferred Stock acquired in the Distributions; and (ii) as to the Series A Preferred Stock held by the Affiliated Holders, no Education Regulatory Approval is required prior to the Affiliated Holders (A) converting a number of Series A Preferred Stock into common stock provided that the number of shares of common stock issued pursuant to such conversion, in the aggregate, is less than or equal to 9.9% of the number of shares of common stock outstanding on an as converted basis as of the date of the Distributions, and (B) voting a number of Series A Preferred Stock provided that the voting power of such Series A Preferred Stock and any shares of common stock issued upon conversion of such Series A Preferred Stock is less than or equal to 9.9% of the voting power of the common stock outstanding as of the date of the Distributions (the foregoing limitations, the “Continuing Caps”).

The removal of the Conversion Cap and Voting Cap became effective as of the date of the Distributions, subject to the Continuing Caps remaining in place with respect to the Series A Preferred Stock distributed to the Affiliated Holders. Education Regulatory Approval continue to be required for, and the Continuing Caps will remain in place with respect to, the Series A Preferred Stock acquired by the Affiliated Holders in the Distributions to the extent such shares, on an as converted basis, represent in excess of 9.9% of our common stock and voting power as of the date of the Distributions. The Affiliated Holders may, at any time, request that we seek Education Regulatory Approval or make a good faith determination that such approval is not required.
F- 31

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)

Optional Conversion by Purchaser

The Series A Preferred Stock are convertible to common stock at any time at the option of the holder. Following the Distributions, the Conversion Cap currently applies to the Affiliated Holders. Additionally, the recipients of the Series A Preferred Stock in the Distributions entered into standard lock-up agreements with the Company restricting the transfer or sale of the Series A Preferred Stock, or any common stock convertible therefrom, for a period of 180 days from the September 14, 2020 distribution date.

Optional Conversion by Our Company

If at any time following the third anniversary of the issuance of the Series A Preferred Stock, the volume weighted average price of our common stock equals or exceeds 2.5 times the conversion price of the Series A Preferred Stock, or $8.33 as of September 30, 2020, for a period of 20 consecutive trading days (“Conversion Trigger”), we may, at our option and subject to obtaining any required stockholder and regulatory approvals, require that any or all of the then outstanding Series A Preferred Stock be automatically converted into our common stock at the conversion rate. We may not elect such conversion during the closed trading window periods in which any director or executive officer of our company is prohibited by us to, directly or indirectly, purchase, sell or otherwise acquire or transfer any equity security of our company. If we are unable to obtain the necessary regulatory approvals to remove the Conversion Cap within 120 days of giving our notice of intent to convert, we will have the option to redeem all of the Series A Preferred Stock at a premium.

Conversion Rate and Conversion Price

The conversion rate for the Series A Preferred Stock will be calculated by dividing the current liquidation preference by the conversion price then in effect. The initial and current conversion price for the Series A Preferred Stock is $3.33 per share. The conversion price is subject to adjustment upon the occurrence of certain common stock events, as defined in the Purchase Agreement, including stock splits, reverse stock splits or the issuance of common stock dividends.

Optional Special Dividend and Conversion on Certain Change of Control

Upon a change of control, at the written election by holders of a majority of the then outstanding shares of Series A Preferred Stock, we shall declare and pay a special cash dividend in the amount equal to either 1.5 or 2.0 times the Cash Dividend rate, depending on the type of change in control, multiplied by the liquidation preference per share then in effect.

Redemption at the Option of Our Company

We have the ability to redeem the Series A Preferred Stock at any time after the third anniversary of the issue date, provided that the Conversion Trigger has not been met on the date of the redemption notice. Holders of the Series A Preferred Stock will be able to convert their shares into common stock if neither the Investor Voting Cap nor Conversion Cap is in effect. If they do not provide notice of conversion within 10 days of receipt of the redemption notice, the redemption will proceed at a price per share equal to the product of the current conversion rate and 2.5 times the conversion price. If either the Investor Voting Cap or Conversion Cap is in effect at the date of the notice of redemption, the holder may request that we obtain the necessary regulatory approval for its removal.

After the tenth anniversary of the issue date, we have the ability to redeem the Series A Preferred Stock in whole or in part at any time. Holders of the Series A Preferred Stock will then be able to convert their shares into common stock if neither the Investor Voting Cap nor Conversion Cap is in effect. If they do not provide notice of conversion within 10 days of receipt of the redemption notice, the redemption will proceed at a price per share equal to the current liquidation preference. If either the Investor Voting Cap or Conversion Cap is in effect at the date of the notice of redemption, the holder may request that we obtain the necessary regulatory approval for its removal.

F- 32

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
Anti-dilution

The conversion price of the Series A Preferred Stock is subject to certain customary anti-dilution protections should we effect certain common stock events, such as stock splits, stock dividends or subdivisions, reclassifications or combinations of our common stock. In such events, the conversion price will be adjusted in a proportionate manner to the change in outstanding share of common stock immediately preceding and immediately after the event.

Reservation of Shares Issuable upon Conversion

We are required, at all times, to reserve and keep available out of our authorized and unissued shares of common stock the number of shares that would be issuable upon conversion of all Series A Preferred Stock, assuming that the Conversion Cap does not apply. If this reserve is not sufficient at any point to allow for full conversion, we shall be required to take action to increase our pool of authorized but unissued shares.

Under the Securities Act, we were not required to register the offer or sale of the Series A Preferred Stock to the Purchaser. In conjunction with the Purchase Agreement, the parties entered into a Registration Rights Agreement in order to grant the Purchaser certain demand and piggyback registration rights covering the purchased shares. In the event that the Purchaser requests such registration of the Series A Preferred Stock, the Registration Rights agreement provides that we shall bear all expenses associated with the registration, with the exception of underwriting discounts and commissions and brokerage fees. On October 18, 2019, we filed a Form S-3 with the Securities and Exchange Commission to register shares of common stock currently held by selling stockholders as well as shares of common stock issuable upon the optional conversion of Series A Convertible Preferred Stock held by the selling stockholders. That registration statement became effective on October 30, 2019.

Equity Offering

On February 20, 2020, we entered into an Underwriting Agreement with B. Riley FBR, Inc., as representative of the several underwriters named therein (the “Underwriters”), to issue and sell an aggregate of 6,782,610 shares (the “Firm Shares”) of our common stock, par value $0.0001 per share (the “Common Stock”), in a public offering, at a price to the public of $7.75 per share, pursuant to a registration statement on Form S-3 (Registration No. 333-236146) (the “Registration Statement”) and the accompanying prospectus, and related prospectus supplement, filed with the SEC (the “Offering”). In addition, we granted the Underwriters an option (“Option”) to purchase up to an additional 1,017,390 shares of the Common Stock for a period of 30 days from February 20, 2020.

The Offering of the Firm Shares closed on February 25, 2020. The net proceeds from the Offering were approximately $49.2 million, after deducting underwriting discounts. Direct costs of $0.4 million related to the offering were recorded to equity during the three months ended March 31, 2020. The Underwriters did not exercise the Option in full for the additional 1,017,390 shares. The 6,782,610 shares purchased were issued from Treasury Stock on February 25, 2020, leaving 82,287 shares in Treasury stock. We intend to use the proceeds for working capital, capital expenditures, and other general corporate purposes, which may include the addition of new campuses, the expansion of existing programs and the development of new programs, and the purchase of real property and campus infrastructure. We may also use a portion of the net proceeds to fund potential strategic acquisitions of complementary businesses, assets, services or technologies.

Share Repurchase Program

On December 20, 2011, our Board of Directors authorized the repurchase of up to $25.0 million of our common stock in the open market or through privately negotiated transactions. The timing and actual number of shares purchased will depend on a variety of factors such as price, corporate and regulatory requirements and prevailing market conditions. We may terminate or limit the share repurchase program at any time without prior notice. During the year ended September 30, 2020, we did not repurchase shares. The last stock repurchase under this stock repurchase program was during fiscal 2015. As of September 30, 2020, we have repurchased 1,677,570 shares at an average price per share of $9.09 and a total cost of approximately $15.3 million under this program. Under the terms of the Certificate of Designations, stock purchases under this program require the approval of a majority of the voting power of the Series A Preferred Stock.

F- 33

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
Note 16 - Stock-Based Compensation

Incentive Compensation Plans

We have two stock-based compensation plans: the Management 2002 Stock Option Program (“2002 Plan”) and the 2003 Incentive Compensation Plan, as amended (“2003 Plan”).

The 2002 Plan was approved by our Board of Directors on April 1, 2002 and provided for the issuance of options to purchase 0.7 million shares of our common stock. On February 25, 2003, our Board of Directors authorized an additional 0.1 million options to purchase our common stock under the 2002 Plan. We do not intend to grant any additional options under the 2002 Plan.

The 2003 Plan was approved by our Board of Directors and adopted effective December 22, 2003 upon consummation of our initial public offering and amended on February 28, 2007 and February 22, 2012 by our stockholders. The 2003 Plan, as amended, authorizes the issuance of various common stock awards, including stock options, restricted stock awards and restricted stock units, for approximately 6.3 million shares of our common stock.

As of September 30, 2020, 2.2 million shares of common stock were reserved for issuance under the 2003 Plan, of which 1.3 million shares are available for future grant.

When recording our stock-based compensation expense, we account for forfeitures as they occur. The following table summarizes the operating expense line and the impact on net income (loss) in the consolidated statements of operations in which stock-based compensation expense has been recorded for the years ended September 30, 2020, 2019, and 2018:

  Year Ended September 30,
2020 2019 2018
Educational services and facilities $ 64  $ —  $ — 
Selling, general and administrative 2,013  1,440  1,864 
Total stock-based compensation expense $ 2,077  $ 1,440  $ 1,864 
Income tax benefit $ 519  $ 360  $ 466 

Stock Options

We issue stock options with exercise prices equal to the closing price of our stock on the grant date and which vest upon issuance. The expiration date of stock options granted under the 2003 Plan is the earlier of the seven or ten-year anniversary of the grant date, based on the terms of the individual grant; the one-year anniversary of the termination of the participant’s employment by reason of death or disability; 90 days after the date of the participant’s termination of employment if caused by reasons other than death, disability, cause, material breach or unsatisfactory performance; or on the termination date if termination occurs for reasons of cause, material breach or unsatisfactory performance.

We estimate the fair value of each stock option grant on the date of grant using the Black-Scholes option-pricing model. The estimated fair value is affected by our stock price, as well as assumptions regarding a number of complex and subjective variables, including, but not limited to, our expected stock price volatility, the expected term of the awards and actual and projected employee stock exercise behaviors. We evaluate our assumptions on the date of each grant.
    
In determining our expected term, we have reviewed our historical share option exercise experience and determined it does not provide a reasonable basis upon which to estimate an expected term due to our limited historical award and exercise experience. Therefore, we have historically assumed the life of the options to be the term of the grant.

F- 34

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
We determine the risk-free interest rate of our awards using the implied yield currently available for zero-coupon U.S. Government issues with a remaining term equal to the expected life of the options.
    
The expected volatility considers the volatility of the Company’s common stock that has been traded for a period commensurate with the expected life. The expected term of options granted represents the period of time that options granted are expected to be outstanding based on historical experience.
    
We have used an expected dividend yield of zero in the Black-Scholes option pricing model.
    
We did not grant stock options during the years ended September 30, 2020 and 2018. We granted 210,000 stock options during the year ended September 30, 2019. The following assumptions were used to value options granted during the year ended September 30, 2019:

Year Ended September 30, 2019
Expected years until exercised 7
Risk-free interest rate 2.84  %
Expected volatility 52.4  %
Expected dividends —  %
    

The following table summarizes stock option activity under the 2003 Plan for the years ended September 30, 2020, 2019 and 2018:
Number of 
Shares
Weighted
Average 
Exercise
Price
Weighted
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Life
Aggregate
Intrinsic
Value
(In thousands) (per Share) (Years)
Outstanding as of September 30, 2017 —  $ —  —  $ — 
Outstanding as of September 30, 2018 —  $ —  —  $ — 
Granted 210  $ 3.14 
Exercised —  $ — 
Forfeited —  $ — 
Outstanding as of September 30, 2019 210  $ 3.14  6.19 $ 483 
Granted —  $ — 
Exercised —  $ — 
Forfeited —  $ — 
Outstanding as of September 30, 2020 210  $ 3.14  5.18 $ 407 
Stock options exercisable as of September 30, 2020 210  $ 3.14  5.18 $ 407 

As of September 30, 2020, there was no unrecognized stock-based compensation expense related to stock options.

F- 35

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
Restricted Stock Units and Performance Units

The following table summarizes the activity for restricted stock units and performance units granted under the 2003 Plan for the years ended September 30, 2020, 2019 and 2018:
RSU PSU
Number of 
Shares
(In thousands)
Weighted Average
Grant Date
Fair Value
per Share
Number of 
Shares
(In thousands)
Weighted Average
Grant Date
Fair Value
per Share
Outstanding as of September 30, 2017 523  $ 3.71  132  $ 3.11 
Granted 350  $ 2.90  182  $ 2.40 
Vested (206) $ 4.51  —  $ — 
Forfeited (95) $ 3.55  (36) $ 2.74 
Outstanding as of September 30, 2018 572  $ 2.95  278  $ 2.69 
Granted —  $ —  —  $ — 
Adjustment to September 2017 grant based on achieved attainment level —  $ —  23 
Vested (228) $ 3.17  (108) $ 3.11 
Forfeited (108) $ 2.96  (60) $ 2.75 
Outstanding as of September 30, 2019 236  $ 2.74  133  $ 2.40 
Granted 306  $ 7.46  314  $ 7.72 
Adjustment to September 2017 grant based on achieved attainment level —  $ —  33 
Vested (141) $ 2.62  (100) $ 2.32 
Forfeited (63) $ 2.96  (39) $ 2.48 
Outstanding as of September 30, 2020 338  $ 7.01  341  $ 7.30 

Restricted Stock Units

Our restricted stock units are issued at fair market value, which is based on the closing prices of our stock on the grant date, discounted for non-participation in anticipated dividends during the vesting period. The restrictions on these units generally lapse ratably over a three or four year period based on the terms of the individual grant. The restrictions associated with our restricted stock units awarded under the 2003 Plan will lapse upon the death, disability, or if, within one year following a change of control, employment is terminated without cause or for good reason. If employment is terminated for any other reason, all shares of restricted stock shall be forfeited upon termination.

As of September 30, 2020, unrecognized stock compensation expense related to restricted stock units was $1.8 million which is expected to be recognized over a weighted average period of 2.4 years.

Performance Units

The performance condition for performance units is compounded annual total shareholder return (“TSR”) for the measurement periods included in the grant. On the settlement date for each measurement period, participants will receive shares of our common stock equal to 0% to 150% of the performance units originally granted depending on the total stockholder return for that measurement period. The performance units vest subject to a market condition and on the settlement date which is expected to be no later than two and a half months after the end of each measurement period. 

We estimate the fair value of performance units using a Monte Carlo simulation which requires assumptions for expected volatility, risk-free rates of return, and dividend yields. Expected volatilities are derived using a method that calculates
F- 36

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
historical volatility over a period equal to the length of the measurement period for UTI. We use a risk-free rate of return that is equal to the yield of a zero-coupon U.S. Treasury bill that is commensurate with each measurement period, and we assume that any dividends paid were reinvested. 

To receive the performance units awarded for a measurement period, participants are required to be employed by us on the settlement date unless one of the following conditions is met. Upon death or disability of a participant, the participant will receive a pro-rated number of performance units reflecting actual performance through the vesting date and the number of months of the performance period during which the participant was employed. If an employee is terminated without cause or leaves for good reason within one year following certain changes in control, a determination of whether, and to what extent the performance condition has been achieved will be based on actual performance against the stated criteria through the separation date. If an employee is terminated without cause or leaves for good reason after the one-year anniversary of certain changes in control, the participant will receive a pro-rated number of performance units reflecting actual performance through the separation date and the number of complete twelve-month periods of the performance period during which the participant was employed. If employment is terminated for any other reason, all unvested performance units shall be forfeited upon termination.

As of September 30, 2020, unrecognized stock compensation expense related to performance units was $1.6 million, which is expected to be recognized over a weighted average period of 1.4 years.
Note 17 - Earnings per Share

We calculate basic earnings per share pursuant to the two-class method as a result of the issuance of the Series A Preferred Stock on June 24, 2016. Our Series A Preferred Stock is considered a participating security because, in the event that we pay a dividend or make a distribution on the outstanding common stock, we shall also pay each holder of the Series A Preferred Stock a dividend on an as-converted basis. The two-class method is an earnings allocation formula that determines earnings per share for common stock and participating securities according to dividend and participation rights in undistributed earnings. Under this method, all earnings, distributed and undistributed, are allocated to common shares and participating securities based on their respective rights to receive dividends. The Series A Preferred Stock is not included in the computation of basic earnings per common share in periods in which we have a net loss as the Series A Preferred Stock is not contractually obligated to share in our net losses.

Diluted earnings per common share is calculated using the more dilutive of the two-class method or as-converted method. The two-class method uses net income available to common shareholders and assumes conversion of all potential shares other than the participating securities. The as-converted method uses net income and assumes conversion of all potential shares including the participating securities. Dilutive potential common shares include outstanding stock options, unvested restricted share awards and units and convertible preferred stock. The basic and diluted weighted average shares outstanding are the same for years ended September 30, 2019 and 2018 as a result of the net loss available to common shareholders and anti-dilutive impact of the potentially dilutive securities.

The following table summarizes the computation of basic and diluted earnings per common share under the two-class or as-converted method, as well as the anti-dilutive shares excluded:
Year Ended September 30,
  2020 2019 2018
Basic earnings per common share:
Net income (loss) $ 8,008  $ (7,868) $ (32,682)
Less: Preferred stock dividend declared (5,264) (5,250) (5,250)
Income (loss) available for distribution 2,744  (13,118) (37,932)
Income allocated to participating securities (1,135) —  — 
Net income (loss) available to common shareholders $ 1,609  $ (13,118) $ (37,932)
F- 37

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
Year Ended September 30,
  2020 2019 2018
Weighted average basic shares outstanding 29,812  25,438  25,115 
Basic income (loss) per common share $ 0.05  $ (0.52) $ (1.51)
Diluted earnings per common share:
Method used: Two-class Two-class Two-class
Net income (loss) available to common shareholders $ 1,609  $ (13,118) $ (37,932)
Weighted average basic shares outstanding 29,812  25,438  25,115 
Dilutive effect related to employee stock plans 301  —  — 
Weighted average diluted shares outstanding 30,113  25,438  25,115 
Diluted income (loss) per common share $ 0.05  $ (0.52) $ (1.51)
Anti-dilutive shares excluded:
Outstanding stock-based grants 14  733  334 
Convertible preferred stock 21,021  21,021  21,021 
   Total anti-dilutive shares excluded 21,035  21,754  21,355 
Dilutive shares under the as-converted method(1)
51,134  46,971  46,382 

(1) The dilutive shares under the as-converted method assume conversion of the preferred stock and are presented here merely for reference. In a net income position, diluted earnings per share is determined by the more dilutive of the two-class method or the as-converted method.

Note 18 - Defined Contribution Employee Benefit Plan

We sponsor a defined contribution 401(k) plan, under which our employees elect to withhold specified amounts from their wages to contribute to the plan and we have a fiduciary responsibility with respect to the plan. The plan provides for matching a portion of employees’ contributions at management’s discretion. All contributions and matches by us are invested at the direction of the employee in one or more mutual funds or cash. We made matching contributions of approximately $1.0 million for the years ended September 30, 2020, 2019 and 2018.

Note 19 - Segment Information
Our principal business is providing postsecondary education. We also provide manufacturer-specific training and these operations are managed separately from our campus operations. These operations do not currently meet the quantitative criteria for segments and therefore are reflected in the Other category. Our equity method investments and other non-Postsecondary Education operations are also included within the Other category. Corporate expenses are allocated to Postsecondary Education and the Other category based on compensation expense. Depreciation and amortization includes amortization of assets subject to finance leases or financing obligations.
F- 38

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
Summary information by reportable segment is as follows:
Postsecondary Education Other Consolidated
Year Ended September 30, 2020
Revenues $ 287,195  $ 13,566  $ 300,761 
Loss from operations (3,493) (378) (3,871)
Depreciation and amortization(1)
11,698  106  11,804 
Net income (loss) 8,386  (378) 8,008 
Year Ended September 30, 2019
Revenues 316,589  14,915  331,504 
Loss from operations (6,685) (1,117) (7,802)
Depreciation and amortization(1)
15,747  157  15,904 
Net loss (7,149) (719) (7,868)
Year Ended September 30, 2018
Revenues 300,753  16,212  316,965 
Loss from operations (31,707) (3,568) (35,275)
Depreciation and amortization(1)
14,978  710  15,688 
Net loss (29,713) (2,969) (32,682)
As of September 30, 2020
Total assets 435,144  6,837  441,981 
As of September 30, 2019
Total assets 263,974  6,552  270,526 

(1) Excludes depreciation of training equipment obtained in exchange for services of $1.3 million, $1.4 million and $1.4 million for the years ended September 30, 2020, 2019 and 2018, respectively.

Note 20 - Government Regulation and Financial Aid

Our institutions are subject to extensive regulatory requirements imposed by a wide range of federal and state agencies, as well as by institutional and programmatic accreditors. These requirements, which are frequently being revisited, revised, and expanded, cover virtually every aspect of our schools’ operations, and our institutions are subject to periodic audits and program compliance reviews by various external agencies for compliance with these requirements. Each of our institutions’ administration of the federal programs of student financial assistance under Title IV of the HEA (“Title IV Programs”) also must be audited annually by independent accountants and the resulting audit report submitted to ED for review. The approvals granted by these regulatory entities permit our schools to operate and to participate in a variety of government-sponsored financial aid programs, including Title IV Programs. If our institutions fail to comply with any of these regulatory requirements, our regulators could take an array of adverse actions, up to and including revocation of the approval granted by the agency. Such adverse actions could have a material adverse effect on our academic or operational initiatives, cash flows, results of operations, or financial condition. Below, we discuss certain, specific elements of this regulatory environment.

F- 39

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
State Authorization

To operate and offer postsecondary programs, and to be certified to participate in Title IV Programs, each of our institutions must obtain and maintain authorization from the state in which it is physically located (“Home State”). To engage in recruiting activities outside of its Home State, each institution also may be required to obtain and maintain authorization from the states in which it is recruiting students. The level of regulatory oversight varies substantially from state to state and is extensive in some states. State laws may establish standards for instruction, qualifications of faculty, location and nature of facilities and equipment, administrative procedures, marketing, recruiting, student outcomes reporting, disclosure obligations to students, limitations on mandatory arbitration clauses in enrollment agreements, financial operations, and other operational matters. Some states prescribe standards of financial responsibility and mandate that institutions post surety bonds. Many states have requirements for institutions to disclose institutional data to current and prospective students, as well as to the public. And some states require that our schools meet prescribed performance standards as a condition of continued approval.

Accreditation

Accreditation is a non-governmental process through which an institution voluntarily submits to ongoing qualitative reviews by an organization of peer institutions. Institutional accreditation by an ED-recognized accreditor is required for an institution to be certified to participate in Title IV Programs. All of our institutions are accredited by the Accrediting Commission of Career Schools and Colleges (“ACCSC”), which is an accrediting agency recognized by ED. ACCSC reviews the academic quality of each institution’s instructional programs, as well as the administrative and financial operations of the institution to ensure that it has the resources necessary to perform its educational mission, implement continuous improvement processes, and support student success. Our institutions must submit annual reports, and at times, supplemental reports, to demonstrate ongoing compliance and improvement. ACCSC requires institutions to disclose certain institutional information to current and prospective students, as well as to the public, and requires that our schools and programs meet various performance standards as a condition of continued accreditation. Institutions must periodically renew their accreditation by completing a comprehensive renewal of accreditation process.

Title IV Programs

The federal government provides a substantial part of its support for postsecondary education through Title IV Programs in the form of grants and loans to students who can use those funds at any institution that has been certified as eligible to participate by ED. All of our institutions are certified to participate in Title IV Programs. In fiscal 2020, we derived approximately 66% of our revenues, on a cash basis as defined by ED, from Title IV Programs. Significant factors relating to Title IV Programs that could adversely affect us include:

The 90/10 Rule. As a condition of participation in Title IV Programs, proprietary institutions must agree when they sign their PPA to derive at least 10% of their revenues for each fiscal year from sources other than Title IV Program funds. A proprietary institution is subject to sanctions if it exceeds the 90% level for a single year, and loses its eligibility to participate in Title IV Programs if it derives more than 90% of its revenue from Title IV Programs for two consecutive fiscal years. As of September 30, 2020, our institutions’ annual Title IV percentages as calculated under the 90/10 rule ranged from approximately 65% to 68%.

Administrative Capability. To continue its participation in Title IV Programs, an institution must demonstrate that it remains administratively capable of providing the education it promises and of properly managing the Title IV Programs. ED assesses the administrative capability of each institution that participates in Title IV Programs under a series of standards listed in the regulations, which cover a wide range of operational and administrative topics, including the designation of capable and qualified individuals, the quality and scope of written procedures, the adequacy of institutional communication and processes, the timely resolution of issues, the sufficiency of recordkeeping, and the frequency of findings of noncompliance, to name a few. ED’s administrative capability standards also include thresholds and expectations for federal student loan cohort default rates (discussed below), satisfactory academic progress, and loan counseling. Failure to satisfy any of the standards may lead ED to find the institution ineligible to participate in Title IV Programs, require the institution to repay Title IV Program funds, change the method of payment of Title IV Program
F- 40

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
funds, or place the institution on provisional certification as a condition of its continued participation or take other actions against the institution.

Three-Year Student Loan Default Rates. To remain eligible to participate in Title IV Programs, institutions also must maintain federal student loan cohort default rates below specified levels. An institution whose three-year cohort default rate is 15% or greater for any one of the three preceding years is subject to a 30-day delay in receiving the first disbursement on federal student loans for first-time borrowers. As of September 30, 2020, only Universal Technical Institute of Texas was subject to a 30-day delay in receiving the first disbursement on federal student loans for first-time borrowers due to a three-year cohort default rate that was 15% or greater for one of the three most recent years. The 30-day delay was lifted as of September 30, 2020 for Universal Technical Institute of Phoenix due to the three-year cohort default rate falling below 15%.

Financial Responsibility. All institutions participating in Title IV Programs also must satisfy specific ED standards of financial responsibility. Among other things, an institution must meet all of its financial obligations, including required refunds to students and any Title IV Program liabilities and debts, be current in its debt payments, comply with certain past performance requirements, not receive an adverse, qualified, or disclaimed opinion by its accountants in its audited financial statements. Each year, ED also evaluates institutions’ financial responsibility by calculating a “composite score,” which utilizes information provided in the institutions’ annual audited financial statements. The composite score is based on three ratios: (1) the equity ratio which measures the institution’s capital resources, ability to borrow and financial viability; (2) the primary reserve ratio which measures the institution’s ability to support current operations from expendable resources; and (3) the net income ratio which measures the institution’s ability to operate at a profit. Between composite score calculations, ED also will reevaluate the financial responsibility of an institution following the occurrence of certain “triggering events,” which must be timely reported to the agency.

Title IV Program Rulemaking. ED is almost continuously engaged in one or more negotiated rulemakings, which is the process pursuant to which it revisits, revises, and expands the complex and voluminous Title IV Program regulations. Recent and significant negotiated rulemakings include the Gainful Employment Rulemaking, the Borrower Defense to Repayment Rulemaking, and the Accreditation and Innovation Rulemaking. New regulations associated with these rulemakings took effect on July 1, 2020. We devote significant effort to understanding the effects of these regulations on our business and to developing compliant solutions that also are congruent with our business, culture, and mission to serve our students and industry relationships. However, we cannot predict with certainty how these new and developing regulatory requirements will be applied or whether each of our schools will be able to comply with all of the requirements in the future.

Other Federal and State Student Aid Programs

Some of our students also receive financial aid from federal sources other than Title IV Programs, such as the programs administered by the VA, the Department of Defense (“DOD”) and under the Workforce Investment Act. Additionally, some states provide financial aid to our students in the form of grants, loans or scholarships. Our Long Beach, Rancho Cucamonga and Sacramento, California campuses, for example, are currently eligible to participate in the Cal Grant program. All of our institutions must comply with the eligibility and participation requirements applicable to each of these funding programs, which vary by funding agency and program.

In 2020, we derived approximately 17% of our revenues, on a cash basis, from veterans’ benefits programs, which include the Post-9/11 GI Bill, the Montgomery GI Bill, the Reserve Education Assistance Program (“REAP”) and VA Vocational Rehabilitation. To continue participation in veterans’ benefits programs, an institution must comply with certain requirements established by the VA.

COVID-19 and the CARES Act

On March 13, 2020, the United States declared a national emergency concerning the COVID-19 pandemic, effective March 1, 2020. ED, consistent with its authority under then-existing statutes and regulations, issued guidance on March 5, 2020, outlining a range of accommodations intended to address interruptions of study related to COVID-19. On March 27, 2020, President Trump signed the CARES Act, which provides additional flexibilities and accommodations, beyond those offered
F- 41

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
by the ED in its March 5, 2020 guidance, particularly with regard to the campus-based assistance programs, the measurement of satisfactory academic progress and the return of unearned Title IV Program funds to ED. Shortly thereafter, on April 3, 2020, ED issued further guidance, providing additional regulatory flexibilities, and in some cases, implementing the accommodations provided for in the CARES Act. ED periodically updated and supplemented this guidance over the following months. Guidance also has been published regarding immigration, discrimination, safety, and privacy issues, as well as the Higher Education Emergency Relief Fund (“HEERF”) established under the CARES Act.

We have reviewed and implemented many of the flexibilities created by the CARES Act and ED’s guidance, including the opportunity to temporarily offer distance education, discussed below. We continue to review new guidance from ED and to implement available legislative and regulatory relief as applicable.

Distance Education

In response to the COVID-19 pandemic, ED provided broad approval for institutions to use distance learning modalities without going through the standard ED approval process for payment periods that begin on or before December 31, 2020. ED also permitted accreditors to waive their distance review requirements. ACCSC has granted institutions temporary approval to offer distance education through December 31, 2020 for the end of the emergency. State agencies have also provided distance education flexibility, but the processes and expiration dates for temporary distance education approval vary by state, and states have been granting extensions to these temporary approvals as they approach expiration. We have availed ourselves of this temporary flexibility in all our programs and we are in full compliance with all state and ACCSC requirements.

To afford us additional flexibility beyond the current temporary approval period(s), we have initiated the approval process with ACCSC, state agencies, or both to be able of offer distance education and a blended learning format for all of our programs on a more permanent basis. Additionally, as a result of previously implementing our Tech II curriculum, we are currently approved to offer distance education at our Avondale, Arizona, Rancho Cucamonga, California, Sacramento, California, Orlando, Florida, Dallas-Ft. Worth, Texas, Long Beach, California and Bloomfield, New Jersey campuses for our Automotive/Diesel Tech II programs by ACCSC, state agencies, or both.


Note 21 - Higher Education Emergency Relief Fund under the CARES Act

The CARES Act established the HEERF. The HEERF includes approximately $14.0 billion in relief funds to be distributed directly to institutions of higher education. The most significant portion of that funding allocation provides that $12.56 billion will be distributed to institutions using a formula based on student enrollment. Of the amount allocated to each institution under this formula, at least 50% must be reserved to provide students with emergency financial aid grants to help cover expenses related to the disruption of campus operations due to coronavirus. The remaining funds must be used “to cover any costs associated with significant changes to the delivery of instruction due to the coronavirus.”

In order to access the HEERF funds, institutions must complete two Funding and Certification Agreements (the “HEERF Agreements”), one for the emergency financial grants to students portion and the other for the institutional portion, which obligate the recipient to administer the funds in a manner that is consistent with the CARES Act and federal laws and regulations cited in the HEERF Agreements. The HEERF Agreements also subject the recipient to a range of audit requirements, as well as quarterly and annual reporting requirements. ED has emphasized that institutions should be prepared to report the use of the funds and to describe any internal controls the institution has in place to ensure that funds were used for allowable purposes and in accordance with cash management principles. The agency also has encouraged institutions to keep detailed records of how they are expending all funds received under the HEERF. A failure to administer the HEERF funds in accordance with applicable laws at regular intervals could result in a future repayment liability.

The allocations to the higher education institutions were set by a formula prescribed in the CARES Act, which is weighted significantly by the number of full-time students who are Pell-eligible, but also takes into consideration the total population of the school and the number of students who were not enrolled full-time online before the COVID-19 outbreak. ED utilized the most recent data available from the Integrated Postsecondary Education Data System and Federal Student Aid for this
F- 42

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
calculation. In May 2020, we were granted approximately $33.0 million in HEERF funds for emergency grants to students and to cover institutional costs associated with significant changes to the delivery of instruction due to coronavirus.

HEERF Funds for Student Grants

Per the HEERF Agreements, at least 50% of HEERF funds received were to be used exclusively for emergency financial aid grants to students impacted by COVID-19, supporting their efforts to stay in school and continue their training toward graduation and future careers. In May 2020, we received approximately $16.5 million designated for student grants and deposited these funds into a separate restricted cash account. As of September 30, 2020, we have awarded all $16.5 million designated for student grants to approximately 9,000 students.

HEERF Funds for Significant Changes to the Delivery of Instruction Due to Coronavirus

In addition, in May of 2020 we were awarded approximately $16.5 million for the institutional portion of the HEERF funds. Such funds may be used to provide additional emergency financial aid grants to students, to cover institutional costs associated with significant changes to the delivery of instruction due to coronavirus, or not used at all and returned to the government.

Per the CARES Act, the HEERF Agreements, and ED guidance, the following requirements are generally applicable to all allowable institutional costs:

Funds may only be used to cover institutional costs associated with significant changes to the delivery of instruction due to the coronavirus.
Costs must have been incurred on or after March 13, 2020.
Funds must generally be spent one calendar year (365 days) from the date of award.
The use of funds must be documented and reported.

As explained in the HEERF Agreements for the Institutional Portions, we have “discretion in determining how to allocate and use the funds provided under the CARES Act, provided the funds will be spent only on those costs for which Recipient has a reasoned basis for concluding such costs have a clear nexus to significant changes to the delivery of instruction due to the coronavirus.” Institutional costs that the ED has specifically designated as allowable include: additional emergency grants to students; reimbursements for refunds made to students for services the institution could no longer provide such as housing, food, room and board, and tuition; technology costs including laptops, hotspots, and other information technology equipment and software to enable students to participate in distance learning; qualified scholarships and payment for future academic terms; payments to a third-party service provider or online program manager for each additional student using the distance learning platform; purchases to ensure the physical safety of the students on campus; and purchases of equipment or software, paying for online licensing fees, or paying for internet service to enable students to transition to distance learning as such costs are associated with a significant change in the delivery of instruction due to the coronavirus. The ED has specifically prohibited costs related to pre-enrollment recruiting activities, endowments, capital outlays associated with facilities to athletics, sectarian instruction, or religious worship, executive compensation, investor benefits, and to pay student balances or student debt.

Prior to the COVID-19 crisis, the majority of our training programs were delivered exclusively through in-person instruction at our campus locations. In order to allow our students to continue their education during the COVID-19 crisis, beginning on March 25, 2020, we shifted our predominantly on-campus, in-person education model to a blended training model that combines instructor-facilitated online teaching and demonstrations with hands-on labs. We incurred significant costs for the initial development and implementation of our online training program for students including software purchases, audio/video equipment purchases and labor hours to record the instructional videos and for training of faculty, and enhancements to the online student experience. In May 2020, we resumed in-person labs at eight of our campus locations. Four of our campuses resumed in-person labs in June 2020, and our final campus to resume in-person labs in Bloomfield, New Jersey opened on July 1, 2020. On-campus labs have been re-designed or modified to meet the guidelines set by the CDC, as well as state and local jurisdictions for health, safety and social distancing. In order to comply with these new guidelines, we incurred costs for sanitization supplies, partitions, labor hours and other related expenses to ensure safety and social distancing. Additionally, we purchased laptops to provide to our students to assist their transition to the online blended
F- 43

Table of Contents

UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(In thousands, except per share amounts)
training model. We also incurred costs as we continued to improve and enhance the delivery of our online instruction for students. In total, we incurred approximately $15.1 million between March 15, 2020 and September 30, 2020 related to the changes in the delivery of instruction due to the coronavirus. We have consulted with our outside regulatory counsel and believe that all of these costs are allowable expenses for the institutional HEERF funds under the CARES Act. However, we cannot guarantee that ED will agree with our foregoing conclusion. We have offset our total operating expenses by $15.1 million for the year ended September 30, 2020. Of the $15.1 million, $13.3 million was recorded in “Educational services and facilities” and $1.8 million was recorded in “Selling, general and administrative” on the consolidated statement of operations for the year ended September 30, 2020.

Additionally, during the year ended September 30, 2020, we used $0.6 million of the institutional funds for additional emergency grants to our students. Including the additional student grants, the total institutional funds spent during fiscal 2020 was $15.7 million.

As of September 30, 2020, we had drawn down $13.9 million of the institutional funds into our operating cash account as partial reimbursement for the $15.7 million of eligible costs incurred during the year ended September 30, 2020. As of September 30, 2020, $2.7 million remained in our G5 account with the ED and is not included in our “Cash and cash equivalents” on our consolidated balance sheet. We drew down the remaining $1.8 million for the eligible costs incurred during the year ended September 30, 2020 in October 2020. As of September 30, 2020, there was approximately $0.8 million of institutional funds remaining to be used for allowable costs incurred after September 30, 2020, which are expected to be used during the first quarter of our fiscal 2021.
Note 22 - Quarterly Financial Summary (Unaudited)
Summarized quarterly financial information for fiscal 2020 and 2019 is as follows:
Year ended September 30, 2020
First
Quarter
Second
Quarter
Third
Quarter
Fourth
Quarter
Fiscal
Year
Revenues $ 87,234  $ 82,717  $ 54,483  $ 76,327  $ 300,761 
Income (loss) from operations 4,254  (499) (13,779) 6,153  (3,871)
Net income (loss) 4,684  10,142  (13,268) 6,450  8,008 
Earnings (loss) per share:
Basic $ 0.07  $ 0.18  $ (0.45) $ 0.10  $ 0.05 
Diluted $ 0.07  $ 0.18  $ (0.45) $ 0.09  $ 0.05 

Year ended September 30, 2019
First
Quarter
Second
Quarter
Third
Quarter
Fourth
Quarter
Fiscal
Year
Revenues $ 83,050  $ 81,746  $ 79,042  $ 87,666  $ 331,504 
(Loss) income from operations (7,205) (5,580) (455) 5,438  (7,802)
Net (loss) income (7,717) (5,263) (365) 5,477  (7,868)
Earnings (loss) per share:
Basic $ (0.36) $ (0.26) $ (0.07) $ 0.09  $ (0.52)
Diluted $ (0.36) $ (0.26) $ (0.07) $ 0.09  $ (0.52)

The sum of quarterly per share information does not equal amounts for the full year as quarterly calculations are performed on a discrete basis. Additionally, securities may have had an anti-dilutive effect during individual quarters but not for the full year.

F- 44

Exhibit 4.6


UNIVERSAL TECHNICAL INSTITUTE, INC.

DESCRIPTION OF THE REGISTRANT’S SECURITIES
REGISTERED PURSUANT TO SECTION 12 OF THE
SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934


The following description of the registered securities of Universal Technical Institute, Inc. is intended as a summary only and therefore is not a complete description. It is subject to and qualified in its entirety by reference to our Restated Certificate of Incorporation (our “Restated Certificate of Incorporation”), Amended and Restated Bylaws (our “Bylaws”), Certificate of Designations of Series A Convertible Preferred Stock (the “Series A Certificate of Designations”), and Certificate of Designation, Preferences and Rights of Series E Junior Participating Preferred Stock (the “Series E Certificate of Designations”), each of which are incorporated by reference as an exhibit to the Annual Report on Form 10-K of which this Exhibit 4.6 is a part. We encourage you to read our Restated Certificate of Incorporation, our Bylaws, Series A Certificate of Designations, Series E Certificate of Designations and the applicable provisions of the General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware (the “DGCL”), for additional information. As used in this Exhibit 4.6, the terms “Company,” “we,” “our,” and “us” refer to Universal Technical Institute, Inc.

General

Our authorized capital stock consists of 100,000,000 shares of common stock, par value $0.0001 per share, and 10,000,000 shares of preferred stock, par value $0.0001 per share, of which (i) 700,000 are designated as Series A Preferred Stock (the “Series A Shares”) and (ii) 100,000 are designated as Series E Junior Participating Preferred Stock (the “Series E Shares”). Our common stock is registered under Section 12(b) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”). Neither the Series A Shares nor the Series E Shares are registered under the Exchange Act.

As of November 30, 2020, there were 32,647,362 shares of our common stock, 700,000 Series A Shares and no Series E Shares outstanding.

Common Stock

Voting Rights

Each share of common stock entitles its holder to one vote. Shares of common stock vote as a single class on all matters on which stockholders are entitled to vote, except as otherwise provided in our Restated Certificate of Incorporation or as required by law. Generally, all matters to be voted on by stockholders, other than the election of directors, must be approved by a majority of the shares of our issued and outstanding capital stock on an as-converted basis present in person or represented by proxy and entitled to vote on the subject matter, voting as a single class. Subject to the rights of the holders of any series of preferred stock to elect directors under certain circumstances, directors must be elected by a plurality of the voting power present in person or represented by proxy and entitled to vote generally in the election of directors.

Dividends

Each share of common stock entitles its holder to receive dividends and other distributions in cash, stock or property as declared by our board of directors (our “Board”), subject to any preferential rights of any outstanding shares of preferred stock and other provisions in our Restated Certificate of Incorporation.


1


Other Rights

Upon liquidation, dissolution or winding up, after payment in full of the amounts required to be paid to creditors and holders of preferred stock, if any, all holders of common stock are entitled to receive a pro rata amount of any distribution of the remaining assets.

No shares of common stock are subject to redemption or conversion or have preemptive rights to purchase additional shares of our common stock or other. There are no sinking fund provisions applicable to our common stock.

Preferred Stock

Our Board has the authority, without any action on the part of our stockholders, to designate and issue preferred stock in one or more series and to designate the rights, powers, preferences and privileges of each series and any qualifications, limitations or restrictions thereof, which may be greater or less than the rights applicable to our common stock.

Undesignated Preferred Stock

It is not possible to state the actual effect of the issuance of any shares of preferred stock upon the rights of holders of common stock until our Board determines the specific rights of the holders of preferred stock. However, the effects might include, among other things:

restricting dividends on common stock;
diluting the voting power of common stock;
impairing the liquidation rights of common stock; or
delaying or preventing our change of control without further action by our stockholders.

Our Board is authorized to determine the terms with respect to the series of preferred stock being offered, which may include (without limitation) the following:

whether dividends on that series of preferred stock will be cumulative or noncumulative;
the dividend rate or method for determining the rate;
the liquidation preference per share of that series of preferred stock, if any;
the conversion provisions applicable to that series of preferred stock, if any;
any redemption or sinking fund provisions applicable to that series of preferred stock;
the voting rights of that series of preferred stock, if any; or
the terms of any other powers, preferences or rights, if any, and the qualifications, limitations or restrictions thereof, applicable to that series of preferred stock.

Series A Preferred Stock

On June 24, 2016, we issued and sold 700,000 Series A Shares to Coliseum Holdings I, LLC (“Coliseum”) for a total purchase price of $70,000,000 pursuant to a Securities Purchase Agreement (the “Purchase Agreement”). In connection with the Purchase Agreement, we filed with the office of the Secretary of State of the State of Delaware the Series A Certificate of Designations, which sets forth the rights and preferences of the Series A Shares. The description below provides a summary of certain material terms of the Series A Shares as set forth in the Series A Certificate of Designations.

Rank

The Series A Shares, with respect to dividend rights and rights upon liquidation, winding up or dissolution, rank senior to our common stock and each other junior class or series of shares that we may issue in the future. The Series A Shares also rank junior to any future indebtedness.
2



Dividends

We may pay a noncumulative cash dividend on each Series A Share at a rate of 7.5% per year on the Liquidation Preference (as defined in the Series A Certificate of Designations) then in effect (“Cash Dividend”). The Cash Dividend is payable before any dividends would be declared or paid to common stockholders or other junior stockholders. If we do not declare and pay a Cash Dividend, the Liquidation Preference on the Series A Shares is increased to an amount equal to the Liquidation Preference in effect at the start of the applicable dividend period, plus an amount equal to such then applicable Liquidation Preference multiplied by the total of the Cash Dividend rate then in effect plus 2.0% per year (an “Accrued Dividend”). If and to the extent declared, Cash Dividends are payable semi-annually in arrears on September 30 and March 31 of each year, and will begin to accrue on the first day of the applicable dividend period.

The Series A Shares have participation rights such that, in the event that we pay a dividend or make a distribution on our outstanding common stock, we are required to also pay to each holder of the Series A Shares a dividend on an as-converted to common stock basis.

If we are required or elect to obtain Regulatory Approval (as defined below) and such approval is not obtained within the time periods set forth in the Series A Certificate of Designations, the dividend rates with respect to the Cash Dividend and the Accrued Dividend will be increased by 5.0% per year, not to exceed a maximum of 14.5% per year. In the event that we ultimately obtain Regulatory Approval after expiration of the time periods set forth in the Series A Certificate of Designations, the increased dividend rates with respect to the Cash Dividend and Accrued Dividend would be reversed.

Liquidation Preference

In the event of voluntary or involuntary liquidation, dissolution or winding up of our company, holders of the Series A Shares are entitled to receive, before any distribution or payment to the holders of any common or junior stock, an amount per Series A Share equal to the Liquidation Preference then in effect, which would include any Accrued Dividends. Alternatively, the holder may choose to receive the amount that would be payable per share of common stock issued upon conversion of the Series A Shares immediately prior to such liquidation event. The initial Liquidation Preference under the Series A Certificate of Designations was $100 per share, the original issue price of the Series A Shares.

Mergers (regardless of whether we remain the surviving entity), a sale of substantially all of our assets or any other recapitalization, reclassification or other transaction in which substantially all of our common stock is exchanged or converted into cash or other property are considered “Deemed Liquidation Events.” The Series A Certificate of Designations provides that, in the case of a Deemed Liquidation Event, each holder of Series A Shares shall be entitled to receive the liquidation amount they would receive under a normal liquidation event; however, such liquidation amount must be in the same form of consideration as is payable to the holders of our common stock.

Voting

Holders of Series A Shares are entitled to vote with the holders of shares of our common stock on an as-converted basis, subject to the Continuing Caps, as discussed and defined below.

A majority of the voting power of the Series A Shares must approve certain significant actions, including, without limitation, (i) the amendment to any provision of our Restated Certificate of Incorporation or Bylaws in a manner adverse to the rights, preferences, privileges or voting powers of the Series A Shares; (ii) the increase of the number of members of our Board above twelve members; (iii) the issuance of certain equity securities; (iv) the repurchase, redemption or acquisition of our common stock; (v) the incurrence of debt other than in a form required by a regulatory agency; (vi) the consummation of certain acquisitions, mergers or other such transactions; and (vii) the sale or license of material assets. The Series A Certificate of Designations defines “Regulatory Approval” as (i) the approvals by the holders of common stock that are required under the listing standards of the New York Stock
3


Exchange (the “NYSE”), including NYSE Listed Company Manual Section 312.03 (“NYSE Rule 312”), and (ii) the approval of any person, entity, or organization that engages in granting or withholding educational approvals for, administers financial assistance to or for students of, or otherwise regulates private postsecondary schools, including without limitation the Department of Education, any state education department or agency, any guaranty agency, and any institutional accreditation agency, in each case, as applicable, to remove the Conversion Cap and Investor Voting Cap (each as defined in the Series A Certificate of Designations) (collectively, the “Regulatory Approval”).

The Conversion Cap and Investor Voting Cap generally prohibit: (i) the conversion of the Series A Shares into common stock; and (ii) the voting of common stock issuable upon conversion of the Series A Shares, to the extent that such conversion results in the issuance of a number of shares of common stock exceeding 4.99% of our outstanding shares of common stock as of June 24, 2016 or that has voting power that exceeds 4.99% of the voting power of our outstanding shares of common stock as of June 24, 2016.

The Series A Certificate of Designations provides that the Conversion Cap and Investor Voting Cap may only be removed upon our receipt of: (i) certain stockholder approvals required by NYSE Rule 312; and (ii) either (A) Education Regulatory Approval (as defined in the Series A Certificate of Designations), or (B) a good faith determination by our Board that Education Regulatory Approval is not required. Our stockholders approved a proposal at the annual meeting of stockholders on February 27, 2020, in accordance with the listing standards of the NYSE in accordance with the requirements of NYSE Rule 312.

In August 2020, Coliseum notified us that it intended to distribute all 700,000 Series A Shares to its members, and that certain of its members would subsequently distribute their Series A Shares to (i) limited partners affiliated with Coliseum and certain other entities for whom Coliseum Capital Management, LLC (an affiliate of Coliseum) holds voting and dispositive power with respect to the Series A Shares (the “Affiliated Holders”), which Affiliated Holders, following such distribution, will own Series A Shares that would represent, on an as-converted basis, approximately 24.9% of our outstanding shares of common stock and voting power, and (ii) limited partners unaffiliated with the Purchaser (the “Unaffiliated Holders”), which Unaffiliated Holders, following such distribution, will each own Series A Shares that would represent, on an as-converted basis, 9.9% or less of our outstanding shares of common stock and voting power (collectively, the “Distributions”).

In connection with the Distributions, our Board, based on advice of legal counsel, determined that: (i) no Education Regulatory Approval is required for the Unaffiliated Holders to remove the Conversion Cap and Investor Voting Cap with respect to the Series A Shares acquired in the Distributions; and (ii) as to the Series A Shares held by the Affiliated Holders, no Education Regulatory Approval is required prior to the Affiliated Holders (A) converting a number of Series A Shares into common stock provided that the number of shares of common stock issued pursuant to such conversion, in the aggregate, is less than or equal to 9.9% of the number of shares of common stock outstanding on an as-converted basis as of the date of the Distributions, and (B) voting a number of Series A Shares, provided that the voting power of such Series A Shares and any shares of common stock issued upon conversion of such Series A Shares is less than or equal to 9.9% of the voting power of the common stock outstanding as of the date of the Distributions (the foregoing limitations, the “Continuing Caps”).

The removal of the Conversion Cap and Investor Voting Cap became effective as of the date of the Distributions, subject to the Continuing Caps remaining in place with respect to the Series A Shares distributed to the Affiliated Holders in connection with the Distributions. Education Regulatory Approval is still required for, and the Continuing Caps remain in place with respect to, the Series A Shares acquired by the Affiliated Holders in the Distributions to the extent such shares, on an as-converted basis, represent greater than 9.9% of our common stock and voting power as of the date of the Distributions. The Affiliated Holders may, at any time, request that we seek Education Regulatory Approval or make a good faith determination that such approval is not required.

Optional Conversion by Coliseum

The Series A Shares are convertible into common stock at the Conversion Rate (as defined the Series A Certificate of Designations) at any time at the option of the holder. Following the Distributions, the Conversion Cap currently only applies to the Affiliated Holders.
4



Optional Conversion by Our Company

If at any time after June 24, 2019, the volume weighted average price of our common stock equals or exceeds 2.5 times the Conversion Price (as defined in the Series A Certificate of Designations) of the Series A Shares for a period of 20 consecutive trading days (the “Conversion Trigger”), we may, at our option and subject to obtaining any required Regulatory Approval, require that any or all of the then outstanding Series A Shares be automatically converted into our common stock at the Conversion Rate. We may not elect to effectuate a conversion during certain time periods, including the closed trading window periods in which any director or executive officer of the Company is prohibited by us to directly or indirectly purchase, sell or otherwise acquire or transfer any of our equity securities. If we are unable to obtain the necessary Regulatory Approval to remove the Conversion Cap within 120 days of giving our notice of intent to convert, we would have the option to redeem all Series A Shares at a premium, and during the time periods, in each case as set forth in the Series A Certificate of Designations.

Conversion Rate and Conversion Price

The Conversion Rate for the Series A Shares will be calculated by dividing the current Liquidation Preference by the Conversion Price then in effect. The initial Conversion Price for the Series A Shares was $3.33 per share. The Conversion Price is subject to adjustment upon the occurrence of certain common stock events, as defined in the Purchase Agreement, including stock splits, reverse stock splits or the issuance of common stock dividends.

Optional Special Dividend and Conversion on Certain Changes of Control

Upon a Change of Control (as defined in the Series A Certificate of Designations), at the written election by the holders of a majority of the then outstanding Series A Shares, we shall declare and pay a special cash dividend in the amount equal to either 1.5 or 2.0 times the Cash Dividend rate, depending on the type of Change of Control, multiplied by the Liquidation Preference per share then in effect.

Redemption at the Option of Our Company

We have the ability to redeem the Series A Shares at any time after June 24, 2019, provided that the Conversion Trigger has not been met on the date of our redemption notice. After receiving our redemption notice, the holders of the Series A Shares will be able to convert their shares into common stock if neither the Conversion Cap nor the Investor Voting Cap is in effect. If the holders of the Series A Shares do not provide notice of conversion within 10 days of receipt of our redemption notice, the redemption will proceed at a price per share equal to the product of the then current Conversion Rate and 2.5 times the Conversion Price. If either the Investor Voting Cap or the Conversion Cap is in effect at the date of our redemption notice, the holders of a majority of the then outstanding Series A Shares may request that we obtain the necessary Regulatory Approval for its removal. If the necessary Regulatory Approval is not obtained within 120 days of such request, we have the ability to effectuate the redemption at a price per share equal to the product of the then current Conversion Rate and the greater of 2.5 times the Conversion Price and the 20-day volume weighted average price of our common stock measured at the close of business on the business day immediately preceding the date of redemption.

After June 24, 2026, we will have the ability to redeem the Series A Shares in whole or in part at any time. After receiving our redemption notice, the holders of the Series A Shares will then be able to convert their shares into common stock if neither the Investor Voting Cap nor the Conversion Cap is in effect. If the holders of the Series A Shares do not provide notice of conversion within 10 days of receipt of our redemption notice, the redemption will proceed at a price per share equal to the Liquidation Preference then in effect. If either the Investor Voting Cap or the Conversion Cap is in effect at the date of our redemption notice, the holders of a majority of the then outstanding Series A Shares may request that we obtain the necessary Regulatory Approval for its removal.

If the Regulatory Approval is not obtained within 120 days of such request, we have the ability to effectuate the redemption at a price per share equal to the greater of the Liquidation Preference then in effect per share and the product of the then current Conversion Rate and the closing price of our common stock on the date immediately
5


preceding the date of such redemption. If at any time prior to our redemption, the necessary Regulatory Approval is obtained, the holders of the Series A Shares have the option to convert such shares into our common stock.

Anti-Dilution

The Conversion Price of the Series A Shares is subject to certain customary anti-dilution protections should we effect certain common stock events, such as stock splits, stock dividends or subdivisions, reclassifications or combinations of our common stock. In such events, the Conversion Price will be adjusted in a proportionate manner to the change in outstanding shares of common stock immediately preceding and immediately after the event.

Reservation of Shares Issuable upon Conversion

We are required, at all times, to reserve and keep available out of our authorized and unissued shares of common stock the number of shares that would be issuable upon conversion of all Series A Shares, assuming that the Conversion Cap does not apply. If this reserve is not sufficient at any point to allow for full conversion, we are required to take action to increase our pool of authorized but unissued shares.

Pursuant to the Series A Certificate of Designations, for so long as Coliseum, its affiliates or any of its or its affiliates’ transferees approved by us beneficially own at least a majority of the then outstanding Series A Shares, the holders of Series A Shares, by the vote or written consent of the holders of a majority of the then outstanding Series A Shares, shall have the right to designate one member to our Board who, subject to applicable law and regulations (including NYSE listing standards), may be appointed to a minimum of two committees of our Board.

Series E Preferred Stock

On June 29, 2016, our Board declared a dividend of one preferred stock purchase right (a “Right”) for each outstanding share of our common stock. The dividend was payable to holders of record as of the close of business on July 11, 2016. The specific terms of the Rights are contained in the Rights Agreement, dated as of June 29, 2016 (as amended, the “Rights Agreement”), by and between the Company and Computershare Inc., as rights agent. Our Board authorized the adoption of the Rights Agreement to protect against any potential future use of coercive or abusive takeover techniques and to help ensure that our stockholders are not deprived of the opportunity to realize the full and fair value of their investment. In general terms, and subject to certain exceptions, the Rights Agreement restricted any person or group from acquiring beneficial ownership of 15% or more of our outstanding common stock, or, in the case of any person or group that owns 15% or more of our outstanding common stock on the date of announcement of our entry into the Rights Agreement, an additional 0.25% of the shares of common stock. The Rights Agreement expired on February 21, 2017, pursuant to the terms of that certain Amendment to Rights Agreement dated February 21, 2017n by and between the Company and Computershare Inc., as rights agent.

In connection with our entry into the Rights Agreement, we filed the Series E Certificate of Designations with the office of the Secretary of State of the State of Delaware, which sets forth the rights and preferences of the Series E Shares. The Series E Certificate of Designations initially designated 100,000 Series E Shares. Our Board may authorize and issue additional Series E Shares, from time to time, without obtaining consent of the holders of Series E Shares. The description below provides a summary of certain material terms of the Series E Shares set forth in the Series E Certificate of Designations.

Rank

The Series E Shares, with respect to dividend rights and rights upon liquidation, winding up or dissolution, ranks senior to our common stock, subject to the prior and superior rights of any series of preferred stock. The Series E Shares rank junior to all other series of preferred stock as to the payment of dividends and the distribution of assets, unless the terms of any such series shall provide otherwise.



6


Dividends

We may pay quarterly dividends payable in cash on the last day of March, June, September and December in each year (each such date being referred to herein as a “Quarterly Dividend Payment Date”), commencing on the first Quarterly Dividend Payment Date after the first issuance of a share or fraction of a Series E Share, in an amount per share (rounded to the nearest cent) equal to the greater of (a) $1.00 or (b) subject to the provision for adjustment as provided in the Series E Certificate of Designations, one thousand (1,000) times the aggregate per share amount of all cash dividends, and 1,000 times the aggregate per share amount (payable in kind) of all non-cash dividends or other distributions other than a dividend payable in shares of common stock or a subdivision of the outstanding shares of common stock (by reclassification or otherwise), declared on the common stock since the immediately preceding Quarterly Dividend Payment Date, or, with respect to the first Quarterly Dividend Payment Date, since the first issuance of any share or fraction of a Series E Share. The Series E Certificate of Designations provides that, at any time after June 29, 2016 (the “Rights Dividend Declaration Date”), in the event we (i) declare any dividend on our common stock payable in shares of common stock, (ii) subdivide the outstanding common stock, or (iii) combine the outstanding common stock into a smaller number of shares, then in each such case the amount to which holders of Series E Shares were entitled immediately prior to such event under clause (ii) of the preceding sentence shall be adjusted by multiplying such amount by a fraction the numerator of which is the number of shares of common stock outstanding immediately after such event and the denominator of which is the number of shares of common stock that were outstanding immediately prior to such event. As long as dividends or distributions payable to the Series E Shares are in arrears, we are restricted from declaring or paying dividends on, making any other distributions on, or redeeming or purchasing or otherwise acquiring for consideration any shares of stock ranking junior (either as to dividends or upon liquidation, dissolution or winding up) to the Series E Shares.
Voting

The Series E Shares are not redeemable. Each Series E Share shall entitle the holder to 1,000 votes on all matters submitted to a vote of our stockholders. Except as otherwise provided in the Series E Certificate of Designations or by law, the holders of Series E Shares and the holders of shares of common stock are entitled to vote together as one class on all matters submitted to a vote of our stockholders.

Anti-Takeover Effects of our Restated Certificate of Incorporation, Bylaws, Series E Certificate of Designations and the DGCL

Some provisions of the DGCL, our Restated Certificate of Incorporation, Bylaws and Series E Certificate of Designations could make the following more difficult:

acquisition of us by means of a tender offer or merger;
acquisition of us by means of a proxy contest or otherwise; or
removal of our incumbent officers and directors.
These provisions, summarized below, are expected to discourage coercive takeover practices and inadequate takeover bids. These provisions also are designed to encourage persons seeking to acquire control of us to first negotiate with our Board. We believe that the benefits of the potential ability to negotiate with the proponent of an unfriendly or unsolicited proposal to acquire or restructure our company outweigh the disadvantages of discouraging those proposals because negotiation of them could result in an improvement of their terms.

Classified Board

Our Restated Certificate of Incorporation provides that our Board will be divided into three classes. The term of each class of directors expires at the end of the third annual meeting of stockholders following the annual meeting at which such director was elected. This system of electing and removing directors may initially discourage a third party from making a tender offer or otherwise attempting to obtain control of us because it generally makes it more difficult for stockholders to replace a majority of our directors.


7


Size of Board and Vacancies

Our Bylaws provide that the number of directors on our Board will be fixed or changed by resolution of a majority of our Board. Except as otherwise provided by a certificate of designations, newly created directorships resulting from any increase in our authorized number of directors or any vacancies in our Board resulting from death, resignation, removal from office or other cause will be filled solely by the majority vote of our remaining directors in office.

No Stockholder Action by Written Consent

Our Restated Certificate of Incorporation provides that subject to the rights of holders of preferred stock to act by written consent, any stockholder action may be effected only at a duly called annual or special meeting of stockholders and may not be effected by a written consent or consents by stockholders in lieu of such a meeting.

Amendment of Our Bylaws

Our Restated Certificate of Incorporation and Bylaws provide that our Bylaws may only be amended by resolution adopted by a majority of our Board, except for certain provisions concerning take-over or change of control which may only be amended with the affirmative vote of two-thirds of the members of our Board.

Amendment of Our Restated Certificate of Incorporation

Our Restated Certificate of Incorporation provides (i) except as otherwise required by law notwithstanding any other provision in the Restated Certificate of Incorporation, the affirmative vote of the holders of at least 66-2/3% of the total voting power of all outstanding shares of capital stock entitled to vote thereon, voting together as a single class, is required to amend, alter, change or repeal, or adopt any provision inconsistent with, Articles V (Board of Directors), VI (Limitation of Liability of Directors), VII (Calling of Special Meeting of Stockholders), VIII (Stockholder Action by Written Consent) and X (Amendment of Certificate of Incorporation).

Stockholder Meetings

Our Restated Certificate of Incorporation and Bylaws provide that except as otherwise required by law and subject to the rights of holders of preferred stock, if any, a special meeting of our stockholders may be called only by the chairman of our Board, our Board pursuant to a resolution adopted by a majority of the total number of directors, whether or not there exist any vacancies or unfilled seats in previously authorized directorships, or a committee that is duly designated by our Board and shall be called by our Secretary by written request.

No business other than that stated in the notice of a special meeting of stockholders may be transacted at such special meeting.

Requirements for Advance Notification of Stockholder Nominations and Proposals

Our Bylaws establish advance notice procedures with respect to stockholder proposals and nomination of candidates for election as directors other than nominations made by or at the direction of our Board or a committee of our Board.

In general, for nominations or other business to be properly brought before an annual meeting by a stockholder, the stockholder must give notice in writing to our Secretary 90 to 120 days before the first anniversary of the preceding year’s annual meeting, or if no annual meeting was held in the preceding year, or if the date of the annual meeting is more than 30 days before or after the anniversary, such notice must be delivered, by the later of the 10th day after the annual meeting is announced or 90 days prior to the date of such meeting, and the business must be a proper matter for stockholder action. Among other things the stockholder’s notice must include for each proposed nominee and business, as applicable, (i) all required information under the Exchange Act, (ii) the proposed nominee’s written consent to serve as a director if elected, (iii) a brief description of the proposed business, (iv) the reasons for
8


conducting the business at the meeting, (v) the stockholder’s material interest in the business, (vi) the stockholder’s name and address and (vii) the class and number of our shares which the stockholder owns.

In general, only such business may be conducted at a special meeting of stockholders as brought before the meeting pursuant to our notice of meeting. At a special meeting of stockholders at which directors are to be elected pursuant to our notice of meeting, a stockholder who is a stockholder of record at the time of giving notice and on the record date for the meeting, who is entitled to vote at the meeting and who complies with the notice procedures, may nominate proposed nominees. In the event we call a special meeting of stockholders to elect one or more directors, a stockholder may nominate a person or persons if the stockholder’s notice is delivered to our Secretary not earlier than 120 days before the meeting nor later than the later of 90 days prior to the meeting and the 10th day after the meeting is announced.

Only such persons who are nominated in accordance with the procedures set forth in our Bylaws may be eligible to serve as directors and only such business may be conducted at a meeting of stockholders as brought before the meeting in accordance with the procedures set forth in our Bylaws. Except as otherwise required by our governing documents, the chairman of the meeting has the power and duty to determine whether a nomination or any business proposed to be brought before the meeting was made or proposed in accordance with the procedures set forth in our Bylaws and, if any proposed nomination or business is not in compliance with our Bylaws, to declare that such defective proposal or nomination shall be disregarded.

Delaware Anti-Takeover Law

Our Restated Certificate of Incorporation subjects us to Section 203 of the DGCL.
In general, Section 203 of the DGCL prohibits a publicly held Delaware corporation from engaging in a business combination with an interested stockholder for a period of three years following the date the person became an interested stockholder, unless the business combination or the transaction in which the person became an interested stockholder is approved in a prescribed manner. Generally, a “business combination” includes a merger, asset or stock sale, or other transaction resulting in a financial benefit to the interested stockholder. Generally, an “interested stockholder” is a person that together with affiliates and associates, owns or within three years prior to the determination of interested stockholder status, did own, 15% or more of a corporation’s voting stock. This may have an anti-takeover effect with respect to transactions not approved in advance by our Board, including discouraging attempts that might result in a premium over the market price for the shares of our capital stock.

No Cumulative Voting

Our Restated Certificate of Incorporation and Bylaws do not provide for cumulative voting in director elections.

Issuance of Series E Preferred Stock

Our Board may issue Series E Shares to protect against any potential future use of coercive or abusive takeover techniques. The Series E Shares, with respect to dividend rights and rights upon liquidation, winding up or dissolution, rank senior to our common stock, subject to the prior and superior rights of any series of preferred stock. Each Series E Share shall entitle the holder to 1,000 votes on all matters submitted to a vote of our stockholders. Except as otherwise provided in the Series E Certificate of Designations or by law, the holders of Series E Shares and the holders of shares of common stock are entitled to vote together as one class on all matters submitted to a vote of our stockholders. Our ability to issue Series E Shares may discourage hostile takeovers.

9

EXHIBIT 21.1
SUBSIDIARIES OF THE REGISTRANT
SUBSIDIARY STATE OF INCORPORATION DBA
UTI Holdings, Inc. Arizona None
Universal Technical Institute of Arizona, Inc. Delaware None
Universal Technical Institute of California, Inc. California None
Universal Technical Institute of Massachusetts, Inc. Delaware None
Universal Technical Institute of North Carolina, Inc. Delaware NASCAR Technical Institute
Universal Technical Institute of Northern Texas, LLC Delaware None
Universal Technical Institute of Pennsylvania, Inc. Delaware None
Universal Technical Institute of Phoenix, Inc. Delaware Universal Technical Institute Motorcycle Mechanics Institute;
Universal Technical Institute Marine Mechanics Institute;
Universal Technical Institute Automotive Division
Universal Technical Institute of Southern California, LLC Delaware None
Universal Technical Institute of Texas, Inc. Texas None
Universal Technical Institute Ventures, LLC Delaware None
U.T.I. of Illinois, Inc. Illinois None
Custom Training Group, Inc. California None


Exhibit 23.1


CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

We consent to the incorporation by reference in Registration Statement Nos. 333-111899, 333-111900, 333-180017, and 333-217492 on Form S-8, and 333-236146 and 333-234253 on Form S-3 of our reports dated December 3, 2020, relating to the consolidated financial statements of Universal Technical Institute, Inc. and subsidiaries, and the effectiveness of Universal Technical Institute, Inc. and subsidiaries’ internal control over financial reporting, appearing in this Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended September 30, 2020.

/s/ DELOITTE & TOUCHE LLP
Phoenix, Arizona
December 3, 2020


Exhibit 31.1

Certification of Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350,
As Adopted Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

I, Jerome A. Grant, certify that:
1.I have reviewed this Report on Form 10-K of Universal Technical Institute, Inc.;
2.Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;
3.Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;
4.The registrant's other certifying officer(s) and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have:
(a)Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;
(b)    Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;
(c)    Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant's disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and
(d)    Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant's internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant's most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant's fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant's internal control over financial reporting; and
5.The registrant's other certifying officer(s) and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant's auditors and the audit committee of the registrant's board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):
(a)All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant's ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and
(b)Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant's internal control over financial reporting.

Date: December 3, 2020
/s/ Jerome A. Grant
Jerome A. Grant
Chief Executive Officer
(Principal Executive Officer)



Exhibit 31.2

Certification of Chief Financial Officer Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350,
As Adopted Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002


I, Troy R. Anderson, certify that:
1.I have reviewed this Report on Form 10-K of Universal Technical Institute, Inc.;
2.Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;
3.Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;
4.The registrant's other certifying officer(s) and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have:
(a)Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;
(b)    Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;
(c)    Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant's disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and
(d)    Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant's internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant's most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant's fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant's internal control over financial reporting; and
5.The registrant's other certifying officer(s) and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant's auditors and the audit committee of the registrant's board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):
(a)All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant's ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and
(b)Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant's internal control over financial reporting.

Date: December 3, 2020
/s/ Troy R. Anderson
Troy R. Anderson
Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer
(Principal Financial Officer and Principal Accounting Officer)


Exhibit 32.1


Certification of CEO Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350,
As Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

In connection with the annual report of Universal Technical Institute, Inc. (the “Company”) on Form 10-K for the period ended September 30, 2020, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on the date hereof (the “Report”), I, Jerome A. Grant, Chief Executive Officer of the Company, certify, to the best of my knowledge, pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, that:
(1)    The Report fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934; and
(2)    The information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company.
Date: December 3, 2020
/s/ Jerome A. Grant
Jerome A. Grant
Chief Executive Officer
(Principal Executive Officer)


This certification accompanies the Annual Report on Form 10-K to which it relates, is not deemed filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission and is not to be incorporated by reference into any filing of Universal Technical Institute, Inc. under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, or the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (whether made before or after the date of the Annual Report on Form 10-K), irrespective of any general incorporation language contained in such filing.




Exhibit 32.2


Certification of CFO Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350,
As Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002


In connection with the annual report of Universal Technical Institute, Inc. (the “Company”) on Form 10-K for the period ended September 30, 2020, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on the date hereof (the “Report”), I, Troy R. Anderson, Chief Financial Officer of the Company, certify, to the best of my knowledge, pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, that:
(1)    The Report fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934; and
(2)    The information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company.
Date: December 3, 2020
/s/ Troy R. Anderson
Troy R. Anderson
Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer
(Principal Financial Officer and Principal Accounting Officer)

This certification accompanies the Annual Report on Form 10-K to which it relates, is not deemed filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission and is not to be incorporated by reference into any filing of Universal Technical Institute, Inc. under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, or the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (whether made before or after the date of the Annual Report on Form 10-K), irrespective of any general incorporation language contained in such filing.